blob: 6362c8b2d9029b418ccbdff87807a3b8a3d32bc8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01005 version 1.5.11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01007 2015/02/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001326log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001327max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328maxconn X X X -
1329mode X X X X
1330monitor fail - X X -
1331monitor-net X X X -
1332monitor-uri X X X -
1333option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1334option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1335option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1336option allbackups (*) X - X X
1337option checkcache (*) X - X X
1338option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1339option contstats (*) X X X -
1340option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1341option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1342option forceclose (*) X X X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1344option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001345option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001346option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001347option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001348option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001349option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1351option httpchk X - X X
1352option httpclose (*) X X X X
1353option httplog X X X X
1354option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001355option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001356option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1358option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1359option logasap (*) X X X -
1360option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001361option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001362option nolinger (*) X X X X
1363option originalto X X X X
1364option persist (*) X - X X
1365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001367option smtpchk X - X X
1368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1370option splice-request (*) X X X X
1371option splice-response (*) X X X X
1372option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1373option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001375option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1377option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1378option tcpka X X X X
1379option tcplog X X X X
1380option transparent (*) X - X X
1381persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1382rate-limit sessions X X X -
1383redirect - X X X
1384redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1385redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1386reqadd - X X X
1387reqallow - X X X
1388reqdel - X X X
1389reqdeny - X X X
1390reqiallow - X X X
1391reqidel - X X X
1392reqideny - X X X
1393reqipass - X X X
1394reqirep - X X X
1395reqisetbe - X X X
1396reqitarpit - X X X
1397reqpass - X X X
1398reqrep - X X X
1399-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1400reqsetbe - X X X
1401reqtarpit - X X X
1402retries X - X X
1403rspadd - X X X
1404rspdel - X X X
1405rspdeny - X X X
1406rspidel - X X X
1407rspideny - X X X
1408rspirep - X X X
1409rsprep - X X X
1410server - - X X
1411source X - X X
1412srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001413stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414stats auth X - X X
1415stats enable X - X X
1416stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001417stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418stats realm X - X X
1419stats refresh X - X X
1420stats scope X - X X
1421stats show-desc X - X X
1422stats show-legends X - X X
1423stats show-node X - X X
1424stats uri X - X X
1425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1426stick match - - X X
1427stick on - - X X
1428stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001429stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001430stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001431tcp-check connect - - X X
1432tcp-check expect - - X X
1433tcp-check send - - X X
1434tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001435tcp-request connection - X X -
1436tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001437tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001438tcp-response content - - X X
1439tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440timeout check X - X X
1441timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001442timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1444timeout connect X - X X
1445timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1447timeout http-request X X X X
1448timeout queue X - X X
1449timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1452timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001453timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001455unique-id-format X X X -
1456unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001458use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1460 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1467
1468
1469acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1470 Declare or complete an access list.
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473 Example:
1474 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1475 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1476 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001481appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1482 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | no | yes | yes
1486 Arguments :
1487 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1488 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 checked in each cookie value.
1492
1493 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1494 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1495 milliseconds.
1496
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001497 request-learn
1498 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1499 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1500 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1501 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1502 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1503 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1504
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001505 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1506 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1507 data following this prefix.
1508
1509 Example :
1510 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1511
1512 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1513 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1514
1515 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1516 2 modes are currently supported :
1517 - path-parameters :
1518 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1519 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1520 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1521 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1522 - query-string :
1523 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1524 query string.
1525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1527 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1528 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1529 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001530 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1531 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1532 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1534 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1535
1536 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 Example :
1543 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001545 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1546 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547
1548
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001549backlog <conns>
1550 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1552 yes | yes | yes | no
1553 Arguments :
1554 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1555 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001556 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557
1558 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1559 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1560 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1561 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1562 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1563 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1564 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1565 backlog parameter.
1566
1567 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1568 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1569 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1570
1571 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1572
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001575balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | no | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1581 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1582 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1583 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1584
1585 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1586 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1587 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1588 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001589 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001590 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001591 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1592 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1593 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1594 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1595 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1596 it, so that you don't worry.
1597
1598 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1599 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1600 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1601 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1602 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1603 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1604 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1605 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001607 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1608 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1609 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1610 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1611 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1612 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1613 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1614 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1615
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001616 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001618 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1619 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001621 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1622 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1623 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1624 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1625 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001626 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1627 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1628 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1629 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1630 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1631 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1635 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1636 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1637 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1638 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1639 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1640 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1644 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1645 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001647 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1648 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1649 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1650 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1651 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1652 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1653 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1654 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1655 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1656 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1657 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1658 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001660 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001661 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1662 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1663 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1664 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1665 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1666 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1667 URIs start with a leading "/".
1668
1669 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1670 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1671 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1672 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1676
1677 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1679 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001680 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1681 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1682 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1683 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001685 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1686 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1689 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1690 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1691 server will receive the request.
1692
1693 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1694 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1695 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1696 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1697 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1699 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1700 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001702 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1703 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1704 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1705 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1706 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1710 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1711 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1712
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1716
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001717 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001718 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001719 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1720 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1721 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1722 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1723 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1724 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 used instead.
1727
1728 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1729 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1730 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1731 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1732
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001733 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1734 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1735 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001737 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1741 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001742
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001743 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1744 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1745 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746
1747 Examples :
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1752 balance hdr(host)
1753 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754
1755 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1756 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001758 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1760 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1761 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1762 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1763
1764 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1765 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1766 defaults to 16 kB.
1767
1768 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1769 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1770
1771 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1772 Round Robin.
1773
1774 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1775 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1776 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1777 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1778
1779 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1780
1781 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001782 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1784 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1785 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1788 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1792bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1795 no | yes | yes | no
1796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001797 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1798 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1799 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1800 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001801 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001802 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1803 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1804 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1805 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1806 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1807 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1808 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001809 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1810 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1811 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1812 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1813 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1814 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1815 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001816 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1817 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1818 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001819 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1820 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1821 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1822 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001823
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001824 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1825 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001826 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1827 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1828 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001829 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1830 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1831 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1832 the range.
1833
1834 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1835 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1836 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1837 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1838 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1839 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1840 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001841 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001842 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1845 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1846 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1847 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1848 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1849 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1850 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1851 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001853 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1854 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1855 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1856 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1859 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1860 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1861 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1862 in a frontend.
1863
1864 Example :
1865 listen http_proxy
1866 bind :80,:443
1867 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001868 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001870 listen http_https_proxy
1871 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001872 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001873
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001874 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1875 bind ipv6@:80
1876 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1877 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1878
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001879 listen external_bind_app1
1880 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001883 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
1885
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001886bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
1891 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1892 may be used to override a default value.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 option may be combined with other numbers.
1896
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1899 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1900 missing from all processes.
1901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001904 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1905 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1906 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1907 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001908
1909 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1910 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1911 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1912 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1913 and 'even' instances.
1914
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001915 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1916 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1917 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1918 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001920 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1921 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1922
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001923 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1924 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1925 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1926
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1928 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1929
1930 Example :
1931 listen app_ip1
1932 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001933 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
1935 listen app_ip2
1936 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001937 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939 listen management
1940 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001943 listen management
1944 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1945 bind-process 1-4
1946
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001947 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950block { if | unless } <condition>
1951 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 no | yes | yes | yes
1954
1955 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1956 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001957 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001958 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1960 "block" statements per instance.
1961
1962 Example:
1963 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1964 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1965 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1966 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
1970
1971capture cookie <name> len <length>
1972 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 no | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1977 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1978 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1979 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1980 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1981
1982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1983 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1984 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1985 right if it exceeds <length>.
1986
1987 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1988 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1989 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1990 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1991
1992 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1993 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1994 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1995
1996 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1997 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1998 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001999 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2000 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2001 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2005
2006 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
2009
2010capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002011 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002016 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2018 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2019 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2020
2021 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2022 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2023 it exceeds <length>.
2024
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2027 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002028 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2029 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2030 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2031 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 environments to find where the request came from.
2034
2035 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2036 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2037 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2038 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002040 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2041 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2042 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2043 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2044 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
2046 Example:
2047 capture request header Host len 15
2048 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2049 capture request header Referrer len 15
2050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 about logging.
2053
2054
2055capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002056 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 no | yes | yes | no
2059 Arguments :
2060 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002061 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2063 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2064 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2065
2066 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2067 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2068 it exceeds <length>.
2069
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2072 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2073 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002074 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2075 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2076 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2077 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002079 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2080 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2081 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2082 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2083 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 Example:
2086 capture response header Content-length len 9
2087 capture response header Location len 15
2088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 about logging.
2091
2092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002093clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | no
2097 Arguments :
2098 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2100 as explained at the top of this document.
2101
2102 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2104 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2105 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2106 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2107 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2108 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2109 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002110 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2112 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2113
2114 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2120
2121 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2122 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2125 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002127compression algo <algorithm> ...
2128compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002129compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002130 Enable HTTP compression.
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 yes | yes | yes | yes
2133 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2135 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2136 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2137
2138 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002139 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002140 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2141 data.
2142
2143 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2144 support for zlib was built in.
2145
2146 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2147 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2148 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2149 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2150 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2151 in.
2152
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002155 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2156 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2157 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2158 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2159 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002160
2161 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2162 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2164 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2165 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002166 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2167 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2168 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2169 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2170 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002171 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2172 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002173
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2176 "Accept-Encoding" header
2177 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002178 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002179 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2180 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2182 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2183 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2184 "multipart"
2185 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2186 header
2187 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2188 and later
2189 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2190 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002191
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002192 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2193 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002194
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002195 Examples :
2196 compression algo gzip
2197 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | no | yes | yes
2203 Arguments :
2204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2206 as explained at the top of this document.
2207
2208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2215
2216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2222
2223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2225 instead.
2226
2227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 yes | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2239 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2240 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2241 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2242 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2243 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2244 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2245 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2246 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2247
2248 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2249 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2250 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2251 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2252 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2253 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2254 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2255 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2256 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2257 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2258 "insert" and "prefix".
2259
2260 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002261 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2265 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2266 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2267 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2268 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2269 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2270 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2271 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2272 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2273 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2276 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2277 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2278 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2279 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2280 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2281 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2282 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2283 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2284 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2286 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2287 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002289 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2290 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2291 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002292 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2293 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2294 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2295 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002296 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2297 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2298 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2301 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2302 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2303 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2304 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2305 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2306 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2307 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2308 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2309
2310 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2311 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2312 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2313 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2314 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2315 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2316 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2317 persistence cookie in the cache.
2318 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2319
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002320 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2321 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2322 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2323 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2324 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2325 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2326 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2327 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2328 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2329 they logout.
2330
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002331 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2332 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2333 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2334 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2335
2336 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2337 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2338 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2339 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2340 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2341 this attribute.
2342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002343 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002345 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2346 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2347 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2348 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2349 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2350 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2353 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2354 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2355 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2356 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2357 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2358 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2359 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2360 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2361 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2362 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2363 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2364 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2365 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2366 the site.
2367
2368 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2369 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2370 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2371 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2372 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2373 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2374 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2375 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2376 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2377 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2378 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2379 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2381 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2382 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2383 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Examples :
2391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002396 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002397 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400default-server [param*]
2401 Change default options for a server in a backend
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2406 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2407 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2408 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002410 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002411 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2412
2413 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416default_backend <backend>
2417 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2419 yes | yes | yes | no
2420 Arguments :
2421 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2422
2423 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2424 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2425 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2426 will catch all undetermined requests.
2427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 Example :
2429
2430 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2431 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2432 default_backend dynamic
2433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002434 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002437description <string>
2438 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : string
2442
2443 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2444 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2445 it describes.
2446 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449disabled
2450 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | yes | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2456 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2457 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2458 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2459 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2460 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2461 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2462
2463 See also : "enabled"
2464
2465
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466dispatch <address>:<port>
2467 Set a default server address
2468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471
2472 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2473 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2474 during start-up.
2475
2476 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2477 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2478 possible with normal servers.
2479
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002480 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2482 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2483 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2484 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2485
2486 See also : "server"
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489enabled
2490 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 yes | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2496 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2497
2498 See also : "disabled"
2499
2500
2501errorfile <code> <file>
2502 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 yes | yes | yes | yes
2505 Arguments :
2506 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002507 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002510 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2513 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
2515 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2516 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2517 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2518
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002519 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2522 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2523 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2524 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2527 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2528 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2529 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2530 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2531 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2534 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2535 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002536 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2538
2539 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 Example :
2542 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2545 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548errorloc <code> <url>
2549errorloc302 <code> <url>
2550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
2553 Arguments :
2554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2558 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2559 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2560 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2561 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2562
2563 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2564 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2565 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2566
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002567 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002569 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2570 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2571 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2572 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2573 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2574 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2575 request.
2576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2578
2579
2580errorloc303 <code> <url>
2581 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2586 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2587
2588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2602 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2603 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002604 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605
2606 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002609force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2610 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2615 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2616 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2617 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2618 marked down for maintenance operations.
2619
2620 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2621 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2622 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2623 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2624 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2625 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2626 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2627 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2628 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2629
2630 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2631 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2632 is used.
2633
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002634 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002635 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002636
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638fullconn <conns>
2639 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2644 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2645
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002646 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002648 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2650 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2651 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2652 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2653 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002656 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2657 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002658 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2659 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2660 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 Example :
2663 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2664 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2665 # connections.
2666 backend dynamic
2667 fullconn 10000
2668 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2672
2673
2674grace <time>
2675 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Arguments :
2679 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2680 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2681 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2682
2683 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2684 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002685 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2687
2688 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2689 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2690 simplify it.
2691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002693hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2696 yes | no | yes | yes
2697 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2699 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2702 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2703 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2704 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2705 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2706 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2707 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2708 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2709 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2710 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2713 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2714 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2715 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2716 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2717 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2718 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2719 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2720 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2721 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2722 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2723 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2724 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2726 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002730 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2732 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2733 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2735 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2736 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002737
2738 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2739 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2741 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2742 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2743 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2744
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002745 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2746 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2747 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2748 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2749 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2750 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2751 parameter.
2752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002753 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2754
2755 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2756 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2757 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2758 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2759 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2760 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2761 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2762 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2763 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2764 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2765 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2766 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002767
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002768 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2769 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2770 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002771
2772 See also : "balance", "server"
2773
2774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775http-check disable-on-404
2776 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 Arguments : none
2780
2781 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2782 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2783 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2784 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2785 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2786 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2787 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2788 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2790 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2791 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2792
2793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2794
2795
2796http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 Arguments :
2801 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2802 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2805 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2806 details on the supported keywords.
2807
2808 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2809 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2810 with the usual backslash ('\').
2811
2812 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2813 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2814 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2815 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2816 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2817
2818 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2821 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823
2824 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2827 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2828 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2829 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2830
2831 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2837 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2838 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2839 trace).
2840
2841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002843 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2844 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2845 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2846 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2847 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2848 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2849
2850 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2851 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2852 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2853 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2854 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2855 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2856 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2857 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2858
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002859 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2860 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2861 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2862
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002863 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2864 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2865
2866 Examples :
2867 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002868 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002869
2870 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002871 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002872
2873 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002874 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875
2876 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002877 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002880
2881
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002882http-check send-state
2883 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 yes | no | yes | yes
2886 Arguments : none
2887
2888 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2889 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2890 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2891 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2892 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2893
2894 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2895 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2896 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2897 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2898 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2899 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2900 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2901 checked in multiple backends.
2902
2903 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2904 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2905
2906 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2907 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2908 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2909 one fails.
2910
2911 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2912 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2913 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2914
2915 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2916 server's queue.
2917
2918 Example of a header received by the application server :
2919 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2920 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2921
2922 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2923
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002924http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002925 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002926 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002927 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2928 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002929 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2930 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2931 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2932 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2933 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2934 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2937
2938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 no | yes | yes | yes
2940
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002941 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2942 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2943 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2944 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2945 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002947 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2948 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2949 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2950
2951 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2952 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2953 are evaluated.
2954
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002955 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2956 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2957 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2958 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2959 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2960 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2961 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2962 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2963 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002964 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002965 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2966
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002967 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2968 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2969 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2970 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2971 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2972
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002973 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2974 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2975 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002976 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2977 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002978
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002979 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2980 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2981 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2982 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2983 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2984 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2985 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2986 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2987
2988 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2989 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2990 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01002991 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
2992 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002993
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002994 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2995 <name>.
2996
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002997 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2998 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2999 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3000 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3001 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3002 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3003 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3004 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3005
3006 Example:
3007
3008 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3009
3010 applied to:
3011
3012 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3013
3014 outputs:
3015
3016 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3017
3018 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3019
3020 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3021 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3022 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3023 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3024 header.
3025
3026 Example:
3027
3028 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3029
3030 applied to:
3031
3032 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3033
3034 outputs:
3035
3036 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3037
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003038 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3039 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3040 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3041 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3042 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3043 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3044 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3045 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3046
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003047 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3048 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3049 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3050 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3051 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3052 another equipment.
3053
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003054 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3055 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3056 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3057 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3058 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3059 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3060 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3061 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3062
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003063 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3064 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3065 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3066 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3067 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3068 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3069 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3070 admin privileges.
3071
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003072 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3073 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3074 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3075 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3076 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3077 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3078 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3079 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3080
3081 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3082 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3083 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3084 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3085 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3086 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3087
3088 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3089 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3090 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3091 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3092 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3093 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3094
3095 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3096 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3097 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3098 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3099 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3100 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3101 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3102 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3103 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3104
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003105 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3106
3107 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3108 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3109 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3110 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003111
3112 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003113 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3114 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3115 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003116
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003117 http-request allow if nagios
3118 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3119 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3120 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003121
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003122 Example:
3123 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003124 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003125
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003126 Example:
3127 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3131 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3132 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3133 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3134 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3135 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3136
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003137 Example:
3138 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3139 acl add path /addacl
3140 acl del path /delacl
3141
3142 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3143
3144 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3145 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3146
3147 Example:
3148 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3149 acl setmap path /setmap
3150 acl delmap path /delmap
3151
3152 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3153
3154 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3155 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3156
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003157 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3158 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003159
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003160http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003161 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003162 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3163 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003164 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3165 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3166 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3167 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3168 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3169 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3172
3173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 no | yes | yes | yes
3175
3176 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3177 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3178 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3179 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3180 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3181 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3182
3183 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3184 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3185 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3186 current section.
3187
3188 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3189 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3190 rules are evaluated.
3191
3192 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3193 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3194 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3195 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3196 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3197 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3198 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3199
3200 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3201 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3202 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3203 external users.
3204
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003205 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3206 <name>.
3207
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003208 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3209 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3210 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3211 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3212 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3213 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3214 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3215 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3216
3217 Example:
3218
3219 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3220
3221 applied to:
3222
3223 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3224
3225 outputs:
3226
3227 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3228
3229 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3230
3231 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3232 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3233 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3234 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3235 header.
3236
3237 Example:
3238
3239 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3240
3241 applied to:
3242
3243 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3244
3245 outputs:
3246
3247 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3248
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003249 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3254 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3255 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3256 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3257
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003258 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3259 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3260 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3261 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3262 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3263 another equipment.
3264
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003265 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3266 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3267 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3268 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3269 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3270 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3271 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3272 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3273
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003274 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3275 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3276 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3277 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3278 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3279 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3280 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3281 admin privileges.
3282
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003283 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3284 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3285 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3286 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3287 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3288 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3289 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3290 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3291
3292 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3293 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3294 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3295 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3296 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3297 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3298
3299 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3300 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3301 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3302 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3303 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3304 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3305
3306 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3307 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3308 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3309 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3310 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3311 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3312 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3313 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3314 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3315
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003316 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3317
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003318 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003319 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3320 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3321 rules.
3322
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003323 Example:
3324 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3325
3326 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3327
3328 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3329 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3330
3331 Example:
3332 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3333
3334 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3335
3336 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3337 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3338
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003339 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3340 ACL usage.
3341
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003342
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003343http-send-name-header [<header>]
3344 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3345
3346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 yes | no | yes | yes
3348
3349 Arguments :
3350
3351 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3352
3353 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3354 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3355 is added with the header string proved.
3356
3357 See also : "server"
3358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003359id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003360 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 no | yes | yes | yes
3363 Arguments : none
3364
3365 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3366 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3367 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003368
3369
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003370ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3371 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 no | yes | yes | yes
3374
3375 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3376 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3377 and running).
3378
3379 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3380 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3381 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003382 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003383 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3384
3385 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3386 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3387
3388 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3389 "unless" condition is met.
3390
3391 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3392
3393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003395log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003396no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003400
3401 Prefix :
3402 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3403 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3404 prefix does not allow arguments.
3405
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406 Arguments :
3407 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3408 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3409 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3410 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3411 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3412 parameter.
3413
3414 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3415 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3416
3417 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3418 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3419 standard syslog port).
3420
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003421 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3422 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3423 standard syslog port).
3424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3426 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3427 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3428 appropriately writeable).
3429
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003430 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3431 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3432 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3433 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3434
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003435 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3436 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3437 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3438 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3439 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3440 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3441 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3442 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3443 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3444 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3445 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3448
3449 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3450 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3451 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3452
3453 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3454 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3455 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003456 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3457 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3458 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3459 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3460 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461
3462 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3463
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003464 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3465 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3466 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003467
3468 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3469 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3470 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3471 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3472
3473 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3474 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475
3476 Example :
3477 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003478 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3479 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003480 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003483log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003484 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003487
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003488 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3489 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3490 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3491 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3492 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003495max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3496 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | no | yes | yes
3499
3500 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3501 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3502 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3503 servers.
3504
3505 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3506 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3507 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3508 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3509 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3510 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3511 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3512 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3513 picking a different server.
3514
3515 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3516 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3517 even if they have to be queued.
3518
3519 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3520 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3521
3522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523maxconn <conns>
3524 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | no
3527 Arguments :
3528 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3529 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3530 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3531 closes.
3532
3533 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3534 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3535 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3536 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3537 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3538 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3539 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3540 properly tuned.
3541
3542 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3543 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3544 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3545
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003546 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3549
3550
3551mode { tcp|http|health }
3552 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3554 yes | yes | yes | yes
3555 Arguments :
3556 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3557 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3558 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3559 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3560
3561 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3562 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3563 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3564 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3565 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3566
3567 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003568 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3569 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3570 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3571 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3572 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3573 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3574 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003576 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3577 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3578 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003580 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581 defaults http_instances
3582 mode http
3583
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003584 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003587monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 Arguments :
3592 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3593 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003594 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3596 backend and its backup.
3597
3598 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3599 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3600 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3601 servers in a list of backends.
3602
3603 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3604 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3605 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3606 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3607 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3608 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3609 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003610 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3611 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 Example:
3614 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3617 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3618 monitor-uri /site_alive
3619 monitor fail if site_dead
3620
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003621 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
3623
3624monitor-net <source>
3625 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | no
3628 Arguments :
3629 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3630 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3631 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3632 followed by a mask.
3633
3634 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3635 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003636 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3638
3639 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3640 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3641 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3642 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003643 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3644 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3645 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003646
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003647 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3648 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3649 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3650 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3651 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3652 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003654 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3655 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003657 Example :
3658 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3659 frontend www
3660 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3661
3662 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3663
3664
3665monitor-uri <uri>
3666 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | no
3669 Arguments :
3670 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3671 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3672
3673 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3674 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3675 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3676 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3677 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3678 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3679 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3680 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3681
3682 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3683 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3684 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3685 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3686 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3687 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3688
3689 Example :
3690 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3691 frontend www
3692 mode http
3693 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3694
3695 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698option abortonclose
3699no option abortonclose
3700 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | no | yes | yes
3703 Arguments : none
3704
3705 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3706 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3707 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3708 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003709 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3711 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3712 encountered while delivering the response.
3713
3714 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3715 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3716 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3717 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3718 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3719 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003720 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003722 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3724 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3725 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3726
3727 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3728 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3729 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3730 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3731 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3732 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3733 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3734 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003735 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003736
3737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3739
3740 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3741
3742
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003743option accept-invalid-http-request
3744no option accept-invalid-http-request
3745 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | no
3748 Arguments : none
3749
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003750 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003751 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3752 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3753 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3754 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3755 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3756 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3757 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003758 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3759 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3760 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3761 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3762 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003763 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
3764 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple
3765 digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003766
3767 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3768 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3769 been confirmed.
3770
3771 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3772 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003773 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3774 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003775 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3776
3777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3779
3780 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3781 stats socket.
3782
3783
3784option accept-invalid-http-response
3785no option accept-invalid-http-response
3786 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 yes | no | yes | yes
3789 Arguments : none
3790
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003791 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003792 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3793 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3794 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3795 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3796 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3797 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3798 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau55645552015-05-01 13:26:00 +02003799 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
3800 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
3801 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003802
3803 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3804 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3805 been confirmed.
3806
3807 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3808 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3809 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3810 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
3815 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3816 stats socket.
3817
3818
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003819option allbackups
3820no option allbackups
3821 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | no | yes | yes
3824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3827 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3828 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3829 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3830 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3831 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3832 order between the backup servers anymore.
3833
3834 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3835 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3836
3837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3839
3840
3841option checkcache
3842no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003843 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3845 yes | no | yes | yes
3846 Arguments : none
3847
3848 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3849 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003850 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003851 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3852 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003853 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003854
3855 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003856 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003857 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003858 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3859 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003860 to the client are :
3861 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003862 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003863 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003864 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3865 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3866 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3867 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3868 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3869 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3870 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3871 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3872 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3873 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3874 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3875
3876 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003877 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003878 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003879 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003880 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3881
3882 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3883 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003884 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003885 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3886
3887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3889
3890
3891option clitcpka
3892no option clitcpka
3893 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3895 yes | yes | yes | no
3896 Arguments : none
3897
3898 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3899 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3900 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3901 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3902
3903 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3904 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3905 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3906 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3907
3908 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3909 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3910 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3911 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3912 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3913
3914 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3915
3916 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3917 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3918 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3919
3920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3922
3923 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3924
3925
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926option contstats
3927 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | no
3930 Arguments : none
3931
3932 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3933 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3934 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3935 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3936 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3937 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3938 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3939
3940
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003941option dontlog-normal
3942no option dontlog-normal
3943 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 yes | yes | yes | no
3946 Arguments : none
3947
3948 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3949 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3950 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3951 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3952 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3953 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3954 logged.
3955
3956 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3957 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3958 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003960 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003961 logging.
3962
3963
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003964option dontlognull
3965no option dontlognull
3966 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3968 yes | yes | yes | no
3969 Arguments : none
3970
3971 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3972 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3973 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3974 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3975 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3976 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003977 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
3978 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
3979 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003980
3981 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3982 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3983 would not be logged.
3984
3985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3987
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02003988 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
3989 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003990
3991
3992option forceclose
3993no option forceclose
3994 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003996 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997 Arguments : none
3998
3999 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4000 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4001 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4002 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4003 global session times in the logs.
4004
4005 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004006 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004007 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004008
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004009 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4010 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4011 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4012
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004013 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4014 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004015
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004016 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4017 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4018
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004019 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004020
4021
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004022option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004023 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | yes | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
4027 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4028 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004029 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004030 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004031
4032 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4033 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4034 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4035 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4036 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4037 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4038 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004039 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4040 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4041 possible that the client has already brought one.
4042
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004043 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004044 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004045 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4046 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004047 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4048 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004049
4050 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4051 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4052 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4053 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4054 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4055 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4056 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4057
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004058 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4059 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4060 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4061 are under the control of the end-user.
4062
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004063 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004064 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4065 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004066 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4067 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4068 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004069
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004070 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004071 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4072 frontend www
4073 mode http
4074 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4075
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004076 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4077 backend www
4078 mode http
4079 option forwardfor header X-Client
4080
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004081 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004082 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004083
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004084
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004085option http-ignore-probes
4086no option http-ignore-probes
4087 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4089 yes | yes | yes | no
4090 Arguments : none
4091
4092 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4093 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4094 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4095 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4096 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4097 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4098 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4099 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4100 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4101 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4102 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4103 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4104
4105 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4106 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4107 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4108 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4109 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4110 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4111 are often the only way to detect them.
4112
4113 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4114 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4115
4116 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4117
4118
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004119option http-keep-alive
4120no option http-keep-alive
4121 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | yes
4124 Arguments : none
4125
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004126 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4127 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4128 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4129 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4130 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4131 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4132 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4133
4134 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4135 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004136 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4137 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4138 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4139 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4140 situations where this option may be useful :
4141
4142 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4143 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4144
4145 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4146 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4147
4148 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4149 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4150 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4151 request.
4152
4153 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4154 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004155 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4156 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4157 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004158
4159 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4160 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4161
4162 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4163 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4164 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4165 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4166 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4167 not set.
4168
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004169 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4170 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004171 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004172 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004173
4174 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004175 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4176 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004177
4178
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004179option http-no-delay
4180no option http-no-delay
4181 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4183 yes | yes | yes | yes
4184 Arguments : none
4185
4186 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4187 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4188 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4189 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4190 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4191 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4192 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4193 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4194 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4195 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4196 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4197 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4198 affected.
4199
4200 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4201 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4202 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4203 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4204 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4205 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4206 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4207 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4208 latency environments.
4209
4210
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004211option http-pretend-keepalive
4212no option http-pretend-keepalive
4213 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 yes | yes | yes | yes
4216 Arguments : none
4217
4218 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4219 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4220 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4221 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4222 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4223 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4224 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4225 consider the response complete.
4226
4227 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4228 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4229 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4230 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4231 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4232 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4233
4234 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4235 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4236 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4237 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4238 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4239 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4240 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4241
4242 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4243 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004244 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004245 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4246 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004247
4248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4250
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004251 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4252 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004253
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004254
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004255option http-server-close
4256no option http-server-close
4257 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4259 yes | yes | yes | yes
4260 Arguments : none
4261
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004262 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4263 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4264 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4265 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4266 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4267 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4268 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4269 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4270 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4271 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4272 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4273 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4274 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4275 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4276 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4277 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004278
4279 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4280 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4281 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4282 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004283 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4284 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004285
4286 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4287 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004288 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4289 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004290 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4291 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004292
4293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4295
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004296 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004297 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4298 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004299
4300
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004301option http-tunnel
4302no option http-tunnel
4303 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 yes | yes | yes | yes
4306 Arguments : none
4307
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004308 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4309 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4310 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4311 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4312 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4313 "option http-tunnel".
4314
4315 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004316 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004317 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4318 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4319 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4320 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4321 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4322 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4323 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004324
4325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4327
4328 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4329 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4330 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4331
4332
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004333option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004334no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004335 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4337 yes | yes | yes | no
4338 Arguments : none
4339
4340 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4341 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4342 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4343 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4344 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4345 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4346 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4347
4348 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4349 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4350 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4351 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4352 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4353 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4354 request along its whole life.
4355
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004356 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4357 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4358 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4359 front of an existing proxy.
4360
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004361 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4362
4363 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4364 http-server-close".
4365
4366
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004367option httpchk
4368option httpchk <uri>
4369option httpchk <method> <uri>
4370option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4371 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | no | yes | yes
4374 Arguments :
4375 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4376 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4377 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4378 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4379 ones.
4380
4381 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4382 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4383 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4384
4385 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4386 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4387 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4388 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4389 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4390
4391 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4392 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4393 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4394 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4395 the lack of any response.
4396
4397 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4398
4399 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4400 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4401 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4402
4403 Examples :
4404 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4405 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4406 backend https_relay
4407 mode tcp
4408 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4409 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4410
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004411 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4412 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4413 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004414
4415
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004416option httpclose
4417no option httpclose
4418 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4420 yes | yes | yes | yes
4421 Arguments : none
4422
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004423 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4424 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4425 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4426 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004427 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004428 "option http-tunnel".
4429
4430 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4431 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4432 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4433 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4434 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4435 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4436 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4437 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004438
4439 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004440 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004441 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4442 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4443 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4444 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4445 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004446
4447 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4448 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004449 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4450 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004451 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4452 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004453
4454 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4455 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4456
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004457 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4458 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004459
4460
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004461option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004462 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004465 Arguments :
4466 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4467 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4468 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4469 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4470 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004471
4472 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4473 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4474 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4475 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4476 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4477 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4478 ports.
4479
4480 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4481
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004482 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4483 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004485 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004486
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004487
4488option http_proxy
4489no option http_proxy
4490 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | yes | yes | yes
4493 Arguments : none
4494
4495 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4496 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4497 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4498 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4499 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4500
4501 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4502 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4503 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4504 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004505 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004506 be analyzed.
4507
4508 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4509 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4510
4511 Example :
4512 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4513 backend direct_forward
4514 option httpclose
4515 option http_proxy
4516
4517 See also : "option httpclose"
4518
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004519
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004520option independent-streams
4521no option independent-streams
4522 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | yes | yes | yes
4525 Arguments : none
4526
4527 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4528 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4529 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4530 receive data or not.
4531
4532 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4533 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4534 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4535 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4536 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4537 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4538 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4539 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4540 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4541 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4542 socket buffers.
4543
4544 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4545 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4546 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4547 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4548 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4549
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004550 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004551 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4552 deprecated.
4553
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004554 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004555
4556
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004557option ldap-check
4558 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4560 yes | no | yes | yes
4561 Arguments : none
4562
4563 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4564 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4565 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4566 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4567
4568 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4569 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4570
4571 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4572 configure it.
4573
4574 Example :
4575 option ldap-check
4576
4577 See also : "option httpchk"
4578
4579
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004580option log-health-checks
4581no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004582 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 yes | no | yes | yes
4585 Arguments : none
4586
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004587 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4588 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4589 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004590
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004591 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4592 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4593 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4594 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4595 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4596
4597 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4598 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004599
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004600 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4601 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4602 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004603
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004604
4605option log-separate-errors
4606no option log-separate-errors
4607 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4609 yes | yes | yes | no
4610 Arguments : none
4611
4612 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4613 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4614 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4615 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4616 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4617 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4618 provides very important information.
4619
4620 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4621 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4622 error logs.
4623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004624 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004625 logging.
4626
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004627
4628option logasap
4629no option logasap
4630 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 yes | yes | yes | no
4633 Arguments : none
4634
4635 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4636 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4637 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4638 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4639 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4640 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4641 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004642 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004643 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4644 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004646 Examples :
4647 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4648 mode http
4649 option httplog
4650 option logasap
4651 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4652
4653 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4654 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4655 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4656 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004658 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004659 logging.
4660
4661
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004662option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004663 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004666 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004667 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4668 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004669 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004670
4671 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4672 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4673 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4674 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4675 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4676 in the MySQL table, like this :
4677
4678 USE mysql;
4679 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4680 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4681
4682 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4683 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4684 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4685 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4686 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4687 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4688 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4689 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4690 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4691
4692 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4693 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004694
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004695 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004696
4697 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4698 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4699 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4700 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4701 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4702 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4703
4704 See also: "option httpchk"
4705
4706
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004707option nolinger
4708no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004709 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004712 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004713
4714 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4715 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4716 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4717 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4718 connections.
4719
4720 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4721 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4722 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4723 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4724 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4725 this too.
4726
4727 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4728 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4729 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4730
4731 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4732 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4733 for servers.
4734
4735 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4736 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4737
4738
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004739option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4740 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | yes | yes | yes
4743 Arguments :
4744 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4745 matching <network>
4746 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4747 header name.
4748
4749 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4750 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4751 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4752 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4753 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4754 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4755 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4756 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4757 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4758 possible that the client has already brought one.
4759
4760 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4761 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4762 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4763 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4764 header and requires different one.
4765
4766 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4767 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4768 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4769 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4770 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4771 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4772 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4773
4774 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4775 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4776 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4777 both are defined.
4778
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004779 Examples :
4780 # Original Destination address
4781 frontend www
4782 mode http
4783 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4784
4785 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4786 backend www
4787 mode http
4788 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4789
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004790 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4791 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004792
4793
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004794option persist
4795no option persist
4796 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004799 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004800
4801 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4802 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4803 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4804 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4805 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4806 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4807 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4808 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4809 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4810 redirected to another valid server.
4811
4812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004815 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004816
4817
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004818option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4819 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | no | yes | yes
4822 Arguments :
4823 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4824 PostgreSQL server.
4825
4826 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4827 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4828 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4829 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4830
4831 See also: "option httpchk"
4832
4833
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004834option prefer-last-server
4835no option prefer-last-server
4836 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | no | yes | yes
4839 Arguments : none
4840
4841 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4842 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4843 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4844 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4845 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4846 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4847 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4848 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4849 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004850 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4851 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4852 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4853 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4854 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4855 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4856 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004857
4858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4860
4861 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4862
4863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004864option redispatch
4865no option redispatch
4866 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4868 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004869 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004870
4871 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4872 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4873 be able to access the service anymore.
4874
4875 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4876 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4877
4878 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4879 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4880 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004882 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4883 "redisp" keywords.
4884
4885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4887
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004888 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004889
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004890
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004891option redis-check
4892 Use redis health checks for server testing
4893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | no | yes | yes
4895 Arguments : none
4896
4897 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4898 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4899 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4900 find the "+PONG" response message.
4901
4902 Example :
4903 option redis-check
4904
4905 See also : "option httpchk"
4906
4907
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004908option smtpchk
4909option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4910 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4912 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004913 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004914 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4915 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4916 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4917
4918 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4919 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4920 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4921
4922 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4923 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4924 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4925 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4926 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4927 dead server.
4928
4929 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4930 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4931 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4932 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4933
4934 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4935 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4936 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4937 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4938 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4939
4940 Example :
4941 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4942
4943 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004946option socket-stats
4947no option socket-stats
4948
4949 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | no
4952
4953 Arguments : none
4954
4955
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004956option splice-auto
4957no option splice-auto
4958 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 yes | yes | yes | yes
4961 Arguments : none
4962
4963 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4964 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4965 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4966 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004967 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004968 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4969 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4970 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4971 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4972
4973 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4974 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4975 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4976 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4977 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4978 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4979 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4980 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4981 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4982 keyword.
4983
4984 Example :
4985 option splice-auto
4986
4987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4989
4990 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4991 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4992
4993
4994option splice-request
4995no option splice-request
4996 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 yes | yes | yes | yes
4999 Arguments : none
5000
5001 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005002 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005003 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5004 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5005 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5006 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5007
5008 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5009
5010 Example :
5011 option splice-request
5012
5013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5015
5016 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5017 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5018
5019
5020option splice-response
5021no option splice-response
5022 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | yes | yes | yes
5025 Arguments : none
5026
5027 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005028 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005029 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5030 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5031 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5032 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5033
5034 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5035
5036 Example :
5037 option splice-response
5038
5039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5041
5042 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5043 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5044
5045
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005046option srvtcpka
5047no option srvtcpka
5048 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5050 yes | no | yes | yes
5051 Arguments : none
5052
5053 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5054 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5055 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5056 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5057
5058 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5059 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5060 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5061 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5062
5063 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5064 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5065 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5066 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5067 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5068
5069 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5070
5071 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5072 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5073 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5074
5075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5077
5078 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5079
5080
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005081option ssl-hello-chk
5082 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5084 yes | no | yes | yes
5085 Arguments : none
5086
5087 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5088 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5089 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5090 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5091 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5092 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5093 hello message.
5094
5095 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5096 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5097 messages, which is appreciable.
5098
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005099 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5100 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5101 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005102
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005103 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5104
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005105
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005106option tcp-check
5107 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5108 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | no | yes | yes
5110
5111 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5112 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5113
5114 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5115 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5116 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5117
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005118 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005119 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5120 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5121 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5122 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5123 only.
5124
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005125 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005126 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5127 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5128 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5129 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5130
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005131 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005132 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5133 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005134 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005135 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5136 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5137 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5138 the respective protocols.
5139 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5140 analysed.
5141
5142 Examples :
5143 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5144 option tcp-check
5145 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5146
5147 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5148 option tcp-check
5149 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5150
5151 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5152 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005153 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005154 option tcp-check
5155 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5156 tcp-check expect +PONG
5157 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5158 tcp-check expect string role:master
5159 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5160 tcp-check expect string +OK
5161
5162 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5163 (send many headers before analyzing)
5164 option tcp-check
5165 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5166 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5167 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5168 tcp-check send \r\n
5169 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5170
5171
5172 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5173
5174
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005175option tcp-smart-accept
5176no option tcp-smart-accept
5177 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | yes | yes | no
5180 Arguments : none
5181
5182 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5183 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5184 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5185 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5186 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5187 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5188
5189 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5190 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5191 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5192 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5193
5194 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5195 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5196 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5197 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5198
5199 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5200 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5201 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5202
5203 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5204 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5205 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5206
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005207 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5208
5209
5210option tcp-smart-connect
5211no option tcp-smart-connect
5212 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 yes | no | yes | yes
5215 Arguments : none
5216
5217 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5218 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5219 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5220 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5221 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5222
5223 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5224 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5225 complex.
5226
5227 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5228 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5229 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5230
5231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5233
5234 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5235
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005236
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005237option tcpka
5238 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | yes | yes | yes
5241 Arguments : none
5242
5243 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5244 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5245 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5246 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5247
5248 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5249 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5250 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5251 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5252
5253 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5254 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5255 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5256 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5257 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5258
5259 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5260
5261 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5262 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5263 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5264 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5265 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5266 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5267 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5268 backends.
5269
5270 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5271
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005272
5273option tcplog
5274 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 yes | yes | yes | yes
5277 Arguments : none
5278
5279 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5280 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5281 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5282 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5283 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5284 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5285 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5286 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5287
5288 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005290 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005291
5292
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005293option transparent
5294no option transparent
5295 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005297 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005298 Arguments : none
5299
5300 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5301 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5302 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5303 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5304 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5305 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5306 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5307 appropriate server.
5308
5309 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5310 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5311
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005312 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005313 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005314
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005315
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005316persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005317persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005318 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | no | yes | yes
5321 Arguments :
5322 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005323 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5324 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005325
5326 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5327 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5328 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5329 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5330 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5331 forwarded to this server.
5332
5333 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5334 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5335 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005336 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005337 a single "listen" section.
5338
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005339 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5340 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5341 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5342
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005343 Example :
5344 listen tse-farm
5345 bind :3389
5346 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5347 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5348 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5349 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5350 persist rdp-cookie
5351 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005352 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005353 balance rdp-cookie
5354 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5355 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5356
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005357 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5358 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005359
5360
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005361rate-limit sessions <rate>
5362 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | yes | yes | no
5365 Arguments :
5366 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5367 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5368
5369 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5370 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5371 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5372 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5373 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5374 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5375
5376 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5377 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5378 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5379 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5380
5381 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5382 listen smtp
5383 mode tcp
5384 bind :25
5385 rate-limit sessions 10
5386 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5387
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005388 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5389 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5390 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005391
5392 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5393
5394
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005395redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5396redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5397redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005398 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 no | yes | yes | yes
5401
5402 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005403 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005404
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005405 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005406 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005407 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5408 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5409 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005410
5411 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5412 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5413 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5414 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5415 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005416 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5417 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5418 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5419 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005420
5421 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5422 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5423 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5424 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5425 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5426 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005427 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005428 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005429 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5430 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5431 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005432
5433 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005434 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5435 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5436 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5437 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5438 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5439 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5440 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5441 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005442
5443 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5444 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5445
5446 - "drop-query"
5447 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5448 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5449 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5450 with a location-type redirect.
5451
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005452 - "append-slash"
5453 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5454 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5455 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5456 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5457
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005458 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5459 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5460 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5461 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5462 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5463 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5464 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5465
5466 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5467 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5468 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5469 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5470 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5471 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5472 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005473
5474 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5475 acl clear dst_port 80
5476 acl secure dst_port 8080
5477 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005478 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005479 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005480 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5481
5482 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005483 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5484 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5485 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005486 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005487
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005488 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5489 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5490 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5491
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005492 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005493 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005494
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005495 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5496 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5497 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005499 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005500
5501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005502redisp (deprecated)
5503redispatch (deprecated)
5504 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005507 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005508
5509 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5510 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5511 be able to access the service anymore.
5512
5513 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5514 redistribute them to a working server.
5515
5516 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5517 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5518 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005520 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5521 "option redispatch" instead.
5522
5523 See also : "option redispatch"
5524
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005525
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005526reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005527 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 no | yes | yes | yes
5530 Arguments :
5531 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5532 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005533 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005534
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005535 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5536 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5537
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005538 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5539 the last header of an HTTP request.
5540
5541 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5542 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5543 responses.
5544
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005545 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5546 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5547 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5548
5549 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5550 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005551
5552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005553reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5554reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005555 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 no | yes | yes | yes
5558 Arguments :
5559 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5560 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5561 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5562 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5563 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5564 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5565 ignores case.
5566
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005567 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5568 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5569
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005570 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5571 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5572 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5573 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005574 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005575
5576 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5577 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5578
5579 Example :
5580 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5581 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5582 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5583
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005584 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5585 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005586
5587
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005588reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5589reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005590 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5592 no | yes | yes | yes
5593 Arguments :
5594 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5595 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5596 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5597 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5598 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5599 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5600
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005601 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5602 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5603
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005604 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5605 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5606 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5607 next servers.
5608
5609 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5610 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5611 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5612
5613 Example :
5614 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5615 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5616 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5617
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005618 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5619 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005620
5621
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005622reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5623reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005624 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5626 no | yes | yes | yes
5627 Arguments :
5628 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5629 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5630 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5631 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5632 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5633 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5634 case.
5635
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005636 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5637 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5638
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005639 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5640 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5641 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5642 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005643 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005644
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005645 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005646 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005647 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005648
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005649 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5650 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5651
5652 Example :
5653 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5654 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5655 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5656
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005657 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5658 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005659
5660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005661reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5662reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005663 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 no | yes | yes | yes
5666 Arguments :
5667 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5668 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5669 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5670 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5671 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5672 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5673 case.
5674
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005675 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5676 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5677
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005678 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5679 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5680 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5681 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5682
5683 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5684 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5685
5686 Example :
5687 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5688 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5689 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5690 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005692 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5693 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005694
5695
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005696reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5697reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005698 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 no | yes | yes | yes
5701 Arguments :
5702 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5703 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5704 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5705 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5706 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5707 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5708
5709 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5710 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5711 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5712 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005714
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005715 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5716 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5717
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005718 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5719 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5720 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5721
5722 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5723 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5724 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5725 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5726 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5727
5728 Example :
5729 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005730 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005731 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5732 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5733
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005734 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5735 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005736
5737
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005738reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5739reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 no | yes | yes | yes
5743 Arguments :
5744 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5745 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5746 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5747 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5748 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5749 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5750 ignores case.
5751
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005752 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5753 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5754
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005755 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5756 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005757 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5758 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5759 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005760 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5761 not set.
5762
5763 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5764 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5765 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5766 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5767 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005769 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005770 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5771 # block all others.
5772 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5773 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5774
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005775 # block bad guys
5776 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5777 reqitarpit . if badguys
5778
5779 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5780 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005781
5782
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005783retries <value>
5784 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 yes | no | yes | yes
5787 Arguments :
5788 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5789 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5790 default value is 3.
5791
5792 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5793 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5794 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5795
5796 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5797 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5798
5799 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5800 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5801
5802 See also : "option redispatch"
5803
5804
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005805rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005806 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 no | yes | yes | yes
5809 Arguments :
5810 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5811 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005812 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005813
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005814 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5815 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5816
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005817 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5818 the last header of an HTTP response.
5819
5820 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5821 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5822 responses.
5823
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005824 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5825 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005826
5827
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005828rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5829rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005830 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 no | yes | yes | yes
5833 Arguments :
5834 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5835 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5836 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5837 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5838 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5839 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5840 ignores case.
5841
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005842 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5843 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5844
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005845 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5846 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005847 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005848 client.
5849
5850 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5851 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5852 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5853
5854 Example :
5855 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005856 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005857
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005858 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5859 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005860
5861
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005862rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5863rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005864 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5866 no | yes | yes | yes
5867 Arguments :
5868 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5869 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5870 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5871 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5872 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5873 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5874 ignores case.
5875
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005876 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5877 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5878
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005879 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5880 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5881 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5882 case-sensitive.
5883
5884 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005885 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5886 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5887 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005888
5889 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5890 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5891
5892 Example :
5893 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5894 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5895
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005896 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5897 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005898
5899
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005900rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5901rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005902 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 no | yes | yes | yes
5905 Arguments :
5906 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5907 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5908 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5909 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5910 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5911 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5912 ignores case.
5913
5914 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5915 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5916 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5917 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005918 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005919
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005920 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5921 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5922
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005923 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5924 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5925 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5926
5927 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5928 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5929 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5930 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5931 are not case-sensitive.
5932
5933 Example :
5934 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5935 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5936
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005937 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5938 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005939
5940
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005941server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005942 Declare a server in a backend
5943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5944 no | no | yes | yes
5945 Arguments :
5946 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005947 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005948 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005949
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005950 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5951 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5952 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5953 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005954 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5955 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5956 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5957 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5958 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005959 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5960 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5961 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5962 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5963 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5964 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5965 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005966 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005967 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5968 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5969 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5970 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005971
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005972 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005973 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5974 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5975 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5976 adding this value to the client's port.
5977
5978 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5979 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005980 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005981
5982 Examples :
5983 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5984 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005985 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005986 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5987 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5988 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005989
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005990 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5991 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005992
5993
5994source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005995source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005996source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005997 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5999 yes | no | yes | yes
6000 Arguments :
6001 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6002 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006003
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006004 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006005 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6006 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6007 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6008 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6009 supported prefixes are :
6010 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6011 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6012 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006013 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006014 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6015 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6016 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6017 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006018
6019 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6020 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006021 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6022 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6023 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006024
6025 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6026 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6027 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6028 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6029 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6030 <addr>.
6031
6032 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6033 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6034 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6035 port.
6036
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006037 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6038 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6039 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6040 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006041 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006042 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6043 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6044 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6045 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6046 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6047 HTTP header.
6048
6049 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6050 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006051 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006052 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6053 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6054 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6055 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6056 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6057 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6058 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6059
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006060 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6061 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6062 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6063 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6064 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6065 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6066
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006067 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6068 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6069 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6070 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6071
6072 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6073 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6074 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6075 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6076 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6077 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6078
6079 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6080 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6081 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6082 there are two methods :
6083
6084 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6085 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6086 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6087 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6088 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6089 of the client ranges may be used.
6090
6091 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6092 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6093 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6094 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6095 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6096 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6097 same session.
6098
6099 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6100 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6101 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6102 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6103 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6104 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6105
6106 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6107 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6108 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006109 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006110
6111 Examples :
6112 backend private
6113 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6114 source 192.168.1.200
6115
6116 backend transparent_ssl1
6117 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6118 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6119
6120 backend transparent_ssl2
6121 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6122 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6123 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6124
6125 backend transparent_ssl3
6126 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6127 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6128 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6129
6130 backend transparent_smtp
6131 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6132 # with Tproxy version 4.
6133 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6134
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006135 backend transparent_http
6136 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6137 # proxy.
6138 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006140 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006141 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006143
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006144srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6145 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6147 yes | no | yes | yes
6148 Arguments :
6149 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6150 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6151 as explained at the top of this document.
6152
6153 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6154 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6155 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6156 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6157 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6158 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6159 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6160
6161 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6162 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6163 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6164 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6165 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006166 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006167 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006168 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006169
6170 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6171 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6172 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6173 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6174 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6175 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6176
6177 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6178 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6179
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006180 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6181 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006182
6183
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006184stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6185 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006187 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006188
6189 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6190 matched.
6191
6192 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6193 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6194
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006195 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6196 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6197 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6198
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006199 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6200 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6201 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6202 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006203
6204 Example :
6205 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6206 backend stats_localhost
6207 stats enable
6208 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6209
6210 Example :
6211 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6212 backend stats_auth
6213 stats enable
6214 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6215 stats admin if TRUE
6216
6217 Example :
6218 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6219 userlist stats-auth
6220 group admin users admin
6221 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6222 group readonly users haproxy
6223 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6224
6225 backend stats_auth
6226 stats enable
6227 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6228 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6229 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6230 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6231
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006232 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6233 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6234 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006235
6236
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006237stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6238 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006240 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006241 Arguments :
6242 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6243
6244 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6245
6246 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6247 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6248 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6249 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6250 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6251 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6252
6253 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6254 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6255 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006256 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006257
6258 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6259 report using "stats scope".
6260
6261 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6262 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6263 unobvious parameters.
6264
6265 Example :
6266 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6267 backend public_www
6268 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6269 stats enable
6270 stats hide-version
6271 stats scope .
6272 stats uri /admin?stats
6273 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6274 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6275 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6276
6277 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6278 backend private_monitoring
6279 stats enable
6280 stats uri /admin?stats
6281 stats refresh 5s
6282
6283 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6284
6285
6286stats enable
6287 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006289 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006290 Arguments : none
6291
6292 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6293 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6294 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6295 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6296 - stats auth : no authentication
6297 - stats scope : no restriction
6298
6299 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6300 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6301 unobvious parameters.
6302
6303 Example :
6304 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6305 backend public_www
6306 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6307 stats enable
6308 stats hide-version
6309 stats scope .
6310 stats uri /admin?stats
6311 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6312 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6313 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6314
6315 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6316 backend private_monitoring
6317 stats enable
6318 stats uri /admin?stats
6319 stats refresh 5s
6320
6321 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6322
6323
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006324stats hide-version
6325 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006327 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006328 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006329
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006330 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6331 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6332 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6333 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6334 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6335 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006337 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6338 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6339 unobvious parameters.
6340
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006341 Example :
6342 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6343 backend public_www
6344 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006345 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006346 stats hide-version
6347 stats scope .
6348 stats uri /admin?stats
6349 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6350 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6351 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006352
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006353 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6354 backend private_monitoring
6355 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006356 stats uri /admin?stats
6357 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006359 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006360
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006361
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006362stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6363 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6364 Access control for statistics
6365
6366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6367 no | no | yes | yes
6368
6369 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6370 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6371 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6372 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6373 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6374 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6375
6376 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6377 instance.
6378
6379 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6380 about ACL usage.
6381
6382
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006383stats realm <realm>
6384 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006386 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006387 Arguments :
6388 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6389 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6390 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6391
6392 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6393 using a backslash ('\').
6394
6395 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6396 only related to authentication.
6397
6398 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6399 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6400 unobvious parameters.
6401
6402 Example :
6403 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6404 backend public_www
6405 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6406 stats enable
6407 stats hide-version
6408 stats scope .
6409 stats uri /admin?stats
6410 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6411 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6412 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6413
6414 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6415 backend private_monitoring
6416 stats enable
6417 stats uri /admin?stats
6418 stats refresh 5s
6419
6420 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6421
6422
6423stats refresh <delay>
6424 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006426 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006427 Arguments :
6428 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6429 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6430 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6431 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6432 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6433 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6434
6435 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6436 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6437 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6438 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6439
6440 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6441 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6442 unobvious parameters.
6443
6444 Example :
6445 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6446 backend public_www
6447 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6448 stats enable
6449 stats hide-version
6450 stats scope .
6451 stats uri /admin?stats
6452 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6453 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6454 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6455
6456 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6457 backend private_monitoring
6458 stats enable
6459 stats uri /admin?stats
6460 stats refresh 5s
6461
6462 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6463
6464
6465stats scope { <name> | "." }
6466 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006468 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006469 Arguments :
6470 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6471 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6472 section in which the statement appears.
6473
6474 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6475 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6476 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6477 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6478 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6479 exists.
6480
6481 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6482 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6483 unobvious parameters.
6484
6485 Example :
6486 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6487 backend public_www
6488 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6489 stats enable
6490 stats hide-version
6491 stats scope .
6492 stats uri /admin?stats
6493 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6494 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6495 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6496
6497 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6498 backend private_monitoring
6499 stats enable
6500 stats uri /admin?stats
6501 stats refresh 5s
6502
6503 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6504
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006505
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006506stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006507 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006509 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006510
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006511 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006512 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6513
6514 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6515 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6516
6517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006519 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006520
6521 Example :
6522 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6523 backend private_monitoring
6524 stats enable
6525 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6526 stats uri /admin?stats
6527 stats refresh 5s
6528
6529 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6530 global section.
6531
6532
6533stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006534 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | yes | yes | yes
6537 Arguments : none
6538
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006539 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006540 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6541 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6542 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6543 - IP (socket, server)
6544 - cookie (backend, server)
6545
6546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006548 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006549
6550 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6551
6552
6553stats show-node [ <name> ]
6554 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006557 Arguments:
6558 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6559 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6560
6561 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6562 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006563 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006564
6565 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6566 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6567 unobvious parameters.
6568
6569 Example:
6570 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6571 backend private_monitoring
6572 stats enable
6573 stats show-node Europe-1
6574 stats uri /admin?stats
6575 stats refresh 5s
6576
6577 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6578 section.
6579
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006580
6581stats uri <prefix>
6582 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006584 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006585 Arguments :
6586 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6587 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6588 query string.
6589
6590 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6591 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6592 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6593 possible to reach it in the application.
6594
6595 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006596 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006597 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6598 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6599 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6600 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6601
6602 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6603 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6604 an address or a port to statistics only.
6605
6606 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6607 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6608 unobvious parameters.
6609
6610 Example :
6611 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6612 backend public_www
6613 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6614 stats enable
6615 stats hide-version
6616 stats scope .
6617 stats uri /admin?stats
6618 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6619 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6620 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6621
6622 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6623 backend private_monitoring
6624 stats enable
6625 stats uri /admin?stats
6626 stats refresh 5s
6627
6628 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6629
6630
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006631stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6632 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006634 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006635
6636 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006637 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006638 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6639 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6640 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6641
6642 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6643 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6644 the "stick-table" statement.
6645
6646 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6647 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6648 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6649 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6650 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6651
6652 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6653 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6654 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6655 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6656 transformation rules.
6657
6658 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6659 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6660 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6661 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6662 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6663 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6664 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6665
6666 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6667 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6668 ACL based conditions.
6669
6670 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6671 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6672 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6673 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6674
6675 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6676 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6677 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6678 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6679
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006680 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6681 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6682 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6683
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006684 Example :
6685 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6686 # last 30 minutes
6687 backend pop
6688 mode tcp
6689 balance roundrobin
6690 stick store-request src
6691 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6692 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6693 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6694
6695 backend smtp
6696 mode tcp
6697 balance roundrobin
6698 stick match src table pop
6699 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6700 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6701
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006702 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006703 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006704
6705
6706stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6707 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 no | no | yes | yes
6710
6711 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6712 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6713 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6714 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6715
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006716 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6717 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6718 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6719
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006720 Examples :
6721 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006722 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006723
6724 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6725 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6726 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6727
6728
6729 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6730 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6731 backend http
6732 mode http
6733 balance roundrobin
6734 stick on src table https
6735 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6736 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6737 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6738
6739 backend https
6740 mode tcp
6741 balance roundrobin
6742 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6743 stick on src
6744 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6745 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6746
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006747 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006748
6749
6750stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6751 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6753 no | no | yes | yes
6754
6755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006756 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006757 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6758 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6759 server is selected.
6760
6761 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6762 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6763 the "stick-table" statement.
6764
6765 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6766 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6767 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6768 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6769 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6770 address.
6771
6772 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6773 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6774 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6775 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6776 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6777 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6778 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6779 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6780 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6781 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6782
6783 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6784 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6785 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6786 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6787 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6788 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6789 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6790
6791 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6792 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6793 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6794 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6795
6796 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6797 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6798 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6799 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6800 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6801 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006802 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6803 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6804 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6805 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6806 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6807 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006808
6809 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6810 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6811 the request.
6812
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006813 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6814 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6815 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6816
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006817 Example :
6818 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6819 # last 30 minutes
6820 backend pop
6821 mode tcp
6822 balance roundrobin
6823 stick store-request src
6824 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6825 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6826 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6827
6828 backend smtp
6829 mode tcp
6830 balance roundrobin
6831 stick match src table pop
6832 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6833 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6834
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006835 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006836 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006837
6838
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006839stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006840 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6841 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006842 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006844 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845
6846 Arguments :
6847 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6848 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6849 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6850 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6851
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006852 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6853 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6854 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6855 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6856
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006857 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6858 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6859 instance.
6860
6861 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6862 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6863 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6864 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6865 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6866 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006867 to 32 characters.
6868
6869 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6870 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6871 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006872 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006873 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6874 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006875
6876 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006877 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6878 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006879 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6880 increase.
6881
6882 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006883 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6884 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6885 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006886
6887 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6888 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6889 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6890 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6891 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6892 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6893 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6894 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6895 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6896 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6897 parameter (see below).
6898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006899 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6900 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6901 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6902 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6903 soft restart.
6904
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006905 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6906
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006907 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6908 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6909 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6910 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6911 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006912 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006913 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6914 if not expiration delay is specified.
6915
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006916 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6917 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6918 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6919 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006920 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6921 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6922 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6923 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6924 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6925 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6926 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6927 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6928 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6929 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6930 types and their arguments.
6931
6932 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6933 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6934 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6935 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6936
6937 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6938 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6939 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6940 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6941
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006942 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6943 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6944 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6945 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6946 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6947 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6948
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006949 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6950 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6951 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6952 they were received.
6953
6954 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6955 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6956 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6957 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6958 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6959
6960 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6961 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6962 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6963 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6964 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6965
6966 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6967 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6968 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6969
6970 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6971 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6972 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6973 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6974 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6975
6976 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6977 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6978 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6979 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6980 the client side.
6981
6982 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6983 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6984 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6985 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6986 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6987 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6988 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6989
6990 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6991 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6992 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6993 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6994 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6995 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6996 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6997
6998 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6999 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7000 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7001 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7002 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7003 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7004
7005 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7006 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7007 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7008 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7009
7010 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7011 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7012 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7013 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7014 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7015 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7016 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7017 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7018 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7019 recommended for better fairness.
7020
7021 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7022 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7023 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7024 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7025
7026 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7027 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7028 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7029 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7030 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7031 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7032 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7033 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7034 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7035 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007036
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007037 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7038 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007039 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7040 reference it.
7041
7042 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7043 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7044 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7045 as an exclusive stickiness.
7046
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007047 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7048 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7049 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7050 something that can be ignored.
7051
7052 Example:
7053 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7054 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7055 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7056 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7057
7058 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007059 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007060
7061
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007062stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7063 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7065 no | no | yes | yes
7066
7067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007068 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007069 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7070 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7071 server is selected.
7072
7073 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7074 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7075 the "stick-table" statement.
7076
7077 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7078 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7079 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7080 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7081
7082 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7083 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7084 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7085 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7086 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7087 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007088 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007089 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7090 rules.
7091
7092 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7093 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7094 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7095 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7096 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7097 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7098 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7099
7100 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7101 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7102 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7103 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7104
7105 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7106 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7107 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7108 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7109 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7110 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007111 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7112 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7113 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7114 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7115 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7116 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7117 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7118 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7119 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007120
7121 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7122
7123 Example :
7124 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7125 backend https
7126 mode tcp
7127 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007128 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007129 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007130
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007131 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7132 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7133
7134 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7135 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7136 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7137
7138 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7139 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007140
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007141 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7142 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7143 # at offset 44.
7144
7145 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7146 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7147
7148 # Learn on response if server hello.
7149 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007150
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007151 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7152 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7153
7154 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7155 extraction.
7156
7157
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007158tcp-check connect [params*]
7159 Opens a new connection
7160 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 no | no | yes | yes
7162
7163 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7164 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7165 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7166
7167 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7168 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7169 of the sequence.
7170
7171 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7172 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7173 do.
7174
7175 Parameters :
7176 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7177 use the TCP connection.
7178
7179 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7180 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7181 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7182
7183 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7184
7185 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7186
7187 Examples:
7188 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7189 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7190 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7191 option tcp-check
7192 tcp-check connect
7193 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7194 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7195 tcp-check send \r\n
7196 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7197 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7198 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7199 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7200 tcp-check send \r\n
7201 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7202 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7203
7204 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7205 option tcp-check
7206 tcp-check connect port 110
7207 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7208 tcp-check connect port 143
7209 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7210 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7211
7212 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7213
7214
7215tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7216 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7218 no | no | yes | yes
7219
7220 Arguments :
7221 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7222 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7223 binary.
7224 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7225 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7226 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7227
7228 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7229 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7230 with the usual backslash ('\').
7231 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7232 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7233 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7234 used upper or lower case.
7235
7236
7237 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7238
7239 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7240 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7241 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7242 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7243 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7244 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7245 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7246 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7247
7248 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7249 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7250 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7251 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7252 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7253 expression.
7254
7255 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7256 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7257 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7258 this exact hexadecimal string.
7259 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7260
7261 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7262 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7263 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7264 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7265 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7266 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7267 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7268 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7269 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7270 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7271 the null character.
7272
7273 Examples :
7274 # perform a POP check
7275 option tcp-check
7276 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7277
7278 # perform an IMAP check
7279 option tcp-check
7280 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7281
7282 # look for the redis master server
7283 option tcp-check
7284 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7285 tcp-check expect +PONG
7286 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7287 tcp-check expect string role:master
7288 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7289 tcp-check expect string +OK
7290
7291
7292 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7293 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7294
7295
7296tcp-check send <data>
7297 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 no | no | yes | yes
7300
7301 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7302 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7303
7304 Examples :
7305 # look for the redis master server
7306 option tcp-check
7307 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7308 tcp-check expect string role:master
7309
7310 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7311 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7312
7313
7314tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7315 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7316 tcp health check
7317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 no | no | yes | yes
7319
7320 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7321 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7322 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7323 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7324 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7325 hexadecimal string.
7326 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7327
7328 Examples :
7329 # redis check in binary
7330 option tcp-check
7331 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7332 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7333
7334
7335 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7336 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7337
7338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007339tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7340 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7342 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007343 Arguments :
7344 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007345 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7346 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007348 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007349
7350 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7351 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007352 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7353 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7354 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7355 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7356 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7357 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007358
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007359 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7360 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7361 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7362 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007363
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007364 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 - accept :
7366 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7367 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7368 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007370 - reject :
7371 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7372 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7373 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7374 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7375 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7376 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7377 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7378 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7379 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7380 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7381 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7382 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007383
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007384 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7385 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7386 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7387 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7388 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7389 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7390 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7391 hosts.
7392
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007393 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7394 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7395 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7396 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7397 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7398 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7399 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7400 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7401 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7402 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7403 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7404
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007405 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7407 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7408 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007409 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7410 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007411 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007412 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7413 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7414 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7415 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7416 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007419 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007420 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007421 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7422 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7423 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7424 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007426 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7427 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7428 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7429 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007431 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7432 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7433 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7434 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7435 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007436 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7437 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7438 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7439 layer7 information is extracted.
7440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007441 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7442 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7443 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7444 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7445 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007446
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007447 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7448 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7449 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007451 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7452 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7453 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007454
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007455 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007456 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007457 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7460 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7461 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007463 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007464 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7465 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007466
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007467 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7468
7469 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7470
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007471 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007473 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007474
7475
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007476tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7477 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007479 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007480 Arguments :
7481 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007482 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007483 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7484 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007486 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007487
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007488 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7489 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7490 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7491 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7492 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007494 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7495 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7496 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7497 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007498 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7499 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7500 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7501 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7502 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7503 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007504 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007505 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007507 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7508 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7509 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7510 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007511
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007512 Four types of actions are supported :
7513 - accept : the request is accepted
7514 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7515 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007516 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007518 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7519 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007520
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007521 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7522 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7523 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7524 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7525 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7526 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007527
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007528 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007529 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7530 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007532 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007533 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7534 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7535 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7536 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007537 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7538 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7539 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007540
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007541 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007542 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7543 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7544 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007545
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007546 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007547 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7548 # and reject everything else.
7549 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7550 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007551 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007552 tcp-request content reject
7553
7554 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007555 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7556 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7557 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007558 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007559
7560 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7561 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7562 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007563 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007564 tcp-request content reject
7565
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007566 Example:
7567 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7568 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007569 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007570
7571 Example:
7572 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7573 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007574 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007575
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007576 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7577 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7578
7579 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007580 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007581 # protecting all our sites
7582 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007583 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7584 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007585 ...
7586 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7587
7588 backend http_dynamic
7589 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007590 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007591 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007592 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7593 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7594 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007595 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007597 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007598
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007599 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007600
7601
7602tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7603 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007605 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007606 Arguments :
7607 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7608 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7609 as explained at the top of this document.
7610
7611 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7612 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7613 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7614 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7615 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7616
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007617 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7618 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7619 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7620 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7621
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007622 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7623 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007624 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007625 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007626 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7627 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7628 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7629 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007630
7631 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7632 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7633 it pass through unaffected.
7634
7635 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7636 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7637 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007638 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007639 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7640 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007641 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7642 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7643 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007644
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007645 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007646 "timeout client".
7647
7648
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007649tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7650 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7652 no | no | yes | yes
7653 Arguments :
7654 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007655 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007656
7657 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7658
7659 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7660 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7661 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007662 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7663 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007664
7665 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7666
7667 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7668 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7669 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7670 inserted.
7671
7672 Two types of actions are supported :
7673 - accept :
7674 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7675 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7676 the rules evaluation.
7677
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007678 - close :
7679 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7680 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7681 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7682 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7683 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7684 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007685 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007686 protocols.
7687
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007688 - reject :
7689 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7690 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007691 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007692
7693 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7694 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7695 for changing the default action to a reject.
7696
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007697 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7698 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7699 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7700 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007701 period.
7702
7703 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7704
7705 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7706
7707
7708tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7709 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7711 no | no | yes | yes
7712 Arguments :
7713 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7714 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7715 as explained at the top of this document.
7716
7717 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7718
7719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007720timeout check <timeout>
7721 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7722 established.
7723
7724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7725 yes | no | yes | yes
7726 Arguments:
7727 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7729 as explained at the top of this document.
7730
7731 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7732 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7733 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7734 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007735 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7736 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7737 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007738
7739 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7740 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7741
7742 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7743 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007744 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007745
7746 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7747 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7748 forget about it.
7749
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007750 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7751 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007752
7753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007754timeout client <timeout>
7755timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7756 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7758 yes | yes | yes | no
7759 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007760 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007761 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7762 as explained at the top of this document.
7763
7764 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7765 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7766 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7767 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7768 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7769 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7770 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7771 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007772 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007773 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007774 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7775 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007776 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7777 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007778
7779 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7780 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7781 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7782 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7783 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7784 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7785
7786 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7787 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7788 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7789
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007790 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007791
7792
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007793timeout client-fin <timeout>
7794 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7796 yes | yes | yes | no
7797 Arguments :
7798 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7799 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7800 as explained at the top of this document.
7801
7802 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7803 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7804 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7805 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7806 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7807 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7808 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7809 down in one direction.
7810
7811 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7812 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7813 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7814
7815 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7816
7817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007818timeout connect <timeout>
7819timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7820 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7822 yes | no | yes | yes
7823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7826 as explained at the top of this document.
7827
7828 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007829 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007830 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007831 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007832 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7833 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007834
7835 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7836 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7837 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7838 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7839 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7840 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7841
7842 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7843 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7844 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7845
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007846 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7847 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007848
7849
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007850timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7851 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 yes | yes | yes | yes
7854 Arguments :
7855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7857 as explained at the top of this document.
7858
7859 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7860 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7861 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7862 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7863 once the request has started to present itself.
7864
7865 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7866 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7867 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7868 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7869 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7870
7871 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7872 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7873 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7874 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7875
7876 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7877 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7878 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7879 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7880 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007881 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007882
7883 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7884 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7885 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7886 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7887
7888 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7889
7890
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007891timeout http-request <timeout>
7892 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007894 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007895 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007896 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007897 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7898 as explained at the top of this document.
7899
7900 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7901 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7902 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7903 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7904 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7905 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7906 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007907 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7908 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7909 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7910 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7911 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007912 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
7913 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007914
7915 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7916 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007917 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7918 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007919
7920 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7921 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7922 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7923 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7924 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7925
7926 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007927 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7928 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7929 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007930
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007931 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
7932 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007933
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007934
7935timeout queue <timeout>
7936 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | no | yes | yes
7939 Arguments :
7940 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7941 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7942 as explained at the top of this document.
7943
7944 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7945 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7946 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7947 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7948 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7949
7950 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7951 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7952 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7953 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7954
7955 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7956
7957
7958timeout server <timeout>
7959timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7960 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | no | yes | yes
7963 Arguments :
7964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7966 as explained at the top of this document.
7967
7968 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7969 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7970 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7971 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7972 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7973 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7974 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7975
7976 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7977 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7978 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7979 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7980 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007981 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007982 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007983 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7984 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7985 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7986 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007987
7988 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7989 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7990 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7991 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7992 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7993 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7994
7995 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7996 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7997 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7998
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007999 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008000
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008001
8002timeout server-fin <timeout>
8003 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8005 yes | no | yes | yes
8006 Arguments :
8007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8009 as explained at the top of this document.
8010
8011 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8012 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8013 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8014 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8015 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8016 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8017 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8018 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8019 situations, it should not be needed.
8020
8021 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8022 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8023 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8024
8025 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8026
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008027
8028timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008029 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8031 yes | yes | yes | yes
8032 Arguments :
8033 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8035 as explained at the top of this document.
8036
8037 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8038 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8039 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8040
8041 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8042 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8043 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8044 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008045 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046
8047 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8048
8049
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008050timeout tunnel <timeout>
8051 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | no | yes | yes
8054 Arguments :
8055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8057 as explained at the top of this document.
8058
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008059 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008060 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8061 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8062 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8063 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8064 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8065 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8066 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8067 specified.
8068
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008069 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8070 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8071 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8072 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8073 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8074 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8075 state.
8076
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008077 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8078 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8079 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8080 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8081 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8082
8083 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8084 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8085 forget about it.
8086
8087 Example :
8088 defaults http
8089 option http-server-close
8090 timeout connect 5s
8091 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008092 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008093 timeout server 30s
8094 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8095
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008096 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008097
8098
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008099transparent (deprecated)
8100 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008102 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008103 Arguments : none
8104
8105 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8106 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8107 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8108 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8109 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8110 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8111 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8112 appropriate server.
8113
8114 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8115
8116 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8117 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8118
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008119 See also: "option transparent"
8120
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008121unique-id-format <string>
8122 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | yes | yes | no
8125 Arguments :
8126 <string> is a log-format string.
8127
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008128 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8129 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8130 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8131 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008133 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8134 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8135 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8136 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8137 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8138 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8139 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8140 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008141
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008142 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8143 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008144
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008145 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008146
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008147 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008148
8149 will generate:
8150
8151 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8152
8153 See also: "unique-id-header"
8154
8155unique-id-header <name>
8156 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | yes | yes | no
8159 Arguments :
8160 <name> is the name of the header.
8161
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008162 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8163 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008164
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008165 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008166
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008167 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008168 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8169
8170 will generate:
8171
8172 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8173
8174 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008175
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008176use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008177 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 no | yes | yes | no
8180 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008181 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8182 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008183
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008184 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8185 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008186
8187 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8188 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8189 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008190 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8191 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8192 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8193 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008194
8195 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8196 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8197 assign the backend.
8198
8199 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8200 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8201 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8202 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8203 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8204 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8205
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008206 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008207 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008208 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8209 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8210 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8211
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008212 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8213 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8214 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8215 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8216 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8217 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8218 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8219 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8220 cannot be forced from the request.
8221
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008222 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008223 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8224 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8225
8226 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8227 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008228
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008229
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008230use-server <server> if <condition>
8231use-server <server> unless <condition>
8232 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | no | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008236 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008237
8238 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8239
8240 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8241 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8242 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8243
8244 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8245 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8246 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8247 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8248 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8249 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8250 matches will assign the server.
8251
8252 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8253 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8254 with the next rules until one matches.
8255
8256 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8257 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8258 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8259 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8260
8261 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8262 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8263 stripped.
8264
8265 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8266 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8267 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8268 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8269
8270 Example :
8271 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8272 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8273 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8274 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8275 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8276 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8277 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8278 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8279 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008281 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008283
82845. Bind and Server options
8285--------------------------
8286
8287The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8288depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8289settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8290written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8291described in this section.
8292
8293
82945.1. Bind options
8295-----------------
8296
8297The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8298as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8299no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8300parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8301while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8302provided immediately after the setting name.
8303
8304The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8305
8306accept-proxy
8307 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008308 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8309 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008310 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8311 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8312 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8313 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8314 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8315 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8316 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008317 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8318 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008319
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008320alpn <protocols>
8321 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8322 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8323 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8324 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8325 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8326 initial NPN extension.
8327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008328backlog <backlog>
8329 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8330 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8331
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008332ecdhe <named curve>
8333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008334 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8335 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008336
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008337ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8339 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8340 client's certificate.
8341
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008342ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8344 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8345 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8346 error is ignored.
8347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008348ciphers <ciphers>
8349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8350 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008351 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008352 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8353 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8354
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008355crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8357 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8358 to verify client's certificate.
8359
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008360crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8362 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8363 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8364 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8365 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8366 file.
8367
8368 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8369 are loaded.
8370
8371 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008372 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8373 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8374 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8375 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8376 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8377 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8378 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008379 www.sub.example.org).
8380
8381 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8382 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8383 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8384 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008385 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8386 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008387
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008388 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008389
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008390 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8391 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008392 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008393 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8394 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8395 clients).
8396
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008397 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8398 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8399 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8400 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8401 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8402 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8403 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8404 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8405 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8406 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8407 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8408 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8409 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8410
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008411crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8413 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008414 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008415 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008416
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008417crt-list <file>
8418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008419 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8420 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008421
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008422 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008423
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008424 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8425 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8426 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8427 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8428 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8429 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8430 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8431 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008433defer-accept
8434 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8435 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8436 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8437 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8438 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8439 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8440 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8441 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8442 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8443 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8444 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8445
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008446force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008447 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008448 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008449 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8450 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008451
8452force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008453 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008454 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8455 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008456
8457force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008458 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008459 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8460 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008461
8462force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008463 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008464 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8465 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008467gid <gid>
8468 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8469 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8470 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8471 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8472 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8473
8474group <group>
8475 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8476 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8477 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8478 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8479 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8480
8481id <id>
8482 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8483 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8484 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8485 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8486
8487interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008488 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8489 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8490 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8491 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8492 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8493 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8494 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008495
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008496level <level>
8497 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8498 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8499 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8500 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8501 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8502 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8503 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8504 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8505 counters).
8506 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8507 all counters).
8508
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008509maxconn <maxconn>
8510 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8511 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8512 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8513 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8514 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8515 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8516 eat all memory.
8517
8518mode <mode>
8519 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8520 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8521 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8522 UNIX sockets.
8523
8524mss <maxseg>
8525 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8526 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8527 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8528 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8529 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8530 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8531 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8532 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8533 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8534 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8535 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8536
8537name <name>
8538 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8539 page.
8540
8541nice <nice>
8542 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8543 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8544 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8545 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8546 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8547 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8548 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8549 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8550 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8551 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8552 one for an RDP socket.
8553
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008554no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008556 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008557 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008558 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8559 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008560 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008561
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008562no-tls-tickets
8563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8564 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8565 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008566 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8567 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008568
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008569no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008571 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008572 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008573 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8574 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8575 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008576
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008577no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008579 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008580 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008581 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8582 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8583 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008584
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008585no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008587 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008588 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008589 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8590 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8591 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008592
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008593npn <protocols>
8594 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8595 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8596 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8597 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008598 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8599 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008600
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008601process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8602 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8603 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8604 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8605 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8606 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8607 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8608 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008609 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8610 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8611 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8612 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8613 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8614 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8615 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008616
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008617ssl
8618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008619 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008620 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8621 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8622 to deciphered contents.
8623
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008624strict-sni
8625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8626 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8627 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8628 See the "crt" option for more information.
8629
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008630tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008631 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008632 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8633 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8634 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8635 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8636 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8637 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8638 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008639 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8640 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8641 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008643transparent
8644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8645 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8646 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8647 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8648 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8649 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8650 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8651 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8652 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8653 so check for support with your vendor.
8654
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008655v4v6
8656 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8657 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8658 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8659 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008660 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008661
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008662v6only
8663 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8664 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8665 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008666 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8667 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008668
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008669uid <uid>
8670 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8673 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8674 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8675
8676user <user>
8677 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8678 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8679 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8680 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8681 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8682
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008683verify [none|optional|required]
8684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8685 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8686 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8687 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8688 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008689 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8690 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8691 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8692 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086945.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008695------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008697The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8698which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8699arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8700settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8701after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8702Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8703address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008705 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008706 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008708The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008709
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008710addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008711 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8712 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8713 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8714 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8715 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008717 Supported in default-server: No
8718
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008719agent-check
8720 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008721 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8722 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8723 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8724 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008725
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008726 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008727 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008728 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8729 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8730 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008731
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008732 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8733 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008734
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008735 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8736 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8737 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008738
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008739 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8740 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8741 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008742
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008743 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8744 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8745 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8746 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8747 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8748 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8749 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008750
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008751 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8752 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008753
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008754 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8755 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8756 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8757 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8758 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8759 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8760 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8761 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8762 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008763
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008764 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8765 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008766 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8767 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8768 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8769 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008770
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008771 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8772 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008773
8774 Supported in default-server: No
8775
8776agent-inter <delay>
8777 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8778 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8779
8780 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8781 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8782 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8783 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8784 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8785 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8786 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8787 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8788 of backends use the same servers.
8789
8790 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8791
8792 Supported in default-server: Yes
8793
8794agent-port <port>
8795 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8796
8797 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8798
8799 Supported in default-server: Yes
8800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008801backup
8802 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8803 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8804 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8805 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8806 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8807 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008809 Supported in default-server: No
8810
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008811ca-file <cafile>
8812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8813 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8814 server's certificate.
8815
8816 Supported in default-server: No
8817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008818check
8819 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008820 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8821 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8822 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8823 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8824 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8825 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8826 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008827 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8828 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8829 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008831 Supported in default-server: No
8832
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008833check-send-proxy
8834 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8835 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8836 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8837 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8838 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8839 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8840 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8841
8842 Supported in default-server: No
8843
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008844check-ssl
8845 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8846 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8847 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8848 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008849 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008850 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8851 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8852 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8853 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8854
8855 Supported in default-server: No
8856
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008857ciphers <ciphers>
8858 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008859 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008860 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8861 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8862 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8863 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8864 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8865 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8866
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008867 Supported in default-server: No
8868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008869cookie <value>
8870 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8871 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8872 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8873 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8874 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8875 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8876 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8877
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008878 Supported in default-server: No
8879
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008880crl-file <crlfile>
8881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8882 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8883 to verify server's certificate.
8884
8885 Supported in default-server: No
8886
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008887crt <cert>
8888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8889 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8890 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8891 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8892 certificate request.
8893
8894 Supported in default-server: No
8895
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008896disabled
8897 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8898 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8899 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8900 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8901 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8902
8903 Supported in default-server: No
8904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008905error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008906 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8907 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8908 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008910 Supported in default-server: Yes
8911
8912 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008914fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008915 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8916 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8917 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8918
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008919 Supported in default-server: Yes
8920
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008921force-sslv3
8922 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8923 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008924 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8925 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008926
8927 Supported in default-server: No
8928
8929force-tlsv10
8930 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008931 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8932 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008933
8934 Supported in default-server: No
8935
8936force-tlsv11
8937 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008938 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8939 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008940
8941 Supported in default-server: No
8942
8943force-tlsv12
8944 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008945 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8946 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008947
8948 Supported in default-server: No
8949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008950id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008951 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8952 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8953 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008954
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008955 Supported in default-server: No
8956
8957inter <delay>
8958fastinter <delay>
8959downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008960 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8961 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8962 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8963 between checks depending on the server state :
8964
8965 Server state | Interval used
8966 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8967 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8968 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8969 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8970 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8971 or yet unchecked. |
8972 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8973 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8974 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008976 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8977 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8978 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8979 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008980 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8981 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8982 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8983 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8984 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008986 Supported in default-server: Yes
8987
8988maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008989 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8990 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8991 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8992 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8993 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8994 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8995 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8996 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8997
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008998 Supported in default-server: Yes
8999
9000maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009001 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9002 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9003 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9004 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9005 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9006 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9007 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9008
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009009 Supported in default-server: Yes
9010
9011minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009012 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9013 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9014 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9015 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9016 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9017 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009018 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009019 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009021 Supported in default-server: Yes
9022
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009023no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009024 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9025 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009026 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009027
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009028 Supported in default-server: No
9029
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009030no-tls-tickets
9031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9032 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9033 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009034 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9035 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009036
9037 Supported in default-server: No
9038
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009039no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009040 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009041 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9042 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009043 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9044 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9045 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009046
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009047 Supported in default-server: No
9048
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009049no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009050 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009051 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9052 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009053 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9054 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9055 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009056
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009057 Supported in default-server: No
9058
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009059no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009060 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009061 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9062 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009063 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9064 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9065 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009066
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009067 Supported in default-server: No
9068
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009069non-stick
9070 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9071 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9072 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9073
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009074 Supported in default-server: No
9075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009076observe <mode>
9077 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9078 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9079 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9080 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9081 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9082 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009083 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009085 Supported in default-server: No
9086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009087 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009089on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009090 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9091 Currently, four modes are available:
9092 - fastinter: force fastinter
9093 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9094 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9095 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9096 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009098 Supported in default-server: Yes
9099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009100 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9101
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009102on-marked-down <action>
9103 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9104 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009105 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9106 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9107 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9108 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9109 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9110 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9111 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9112 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009113
9114 Actions are disabled by default
9115
9116 Supported in default-server: Yes
9117
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009118on-marked-up <action>
9119 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9120 Currently one action is available:
9121 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9122 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9123 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9124 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9125 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9126 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9127 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9128 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9129
9130 Actions are disabled by default
9131
9132 Supported in default-server: Yes
9133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009134port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9136 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9137 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9138 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9139 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9140 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009142 Supported in default-server: Yes
9143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009144redir <prefix>
9145 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9146 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9147 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9148 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9149 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9150 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9151 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9152 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009153 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009154 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9155 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9156 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9157 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9158 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9159
9160 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009162 Supported in default-server: No
9163
9164rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009165 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9166 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9167 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009169 Supported in default-server: Yes
9170
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009171send-proxy
9172 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9173 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9174 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9175 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9176 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9177 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9178 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9179 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9180 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009181 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9182 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9183 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9184 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9185 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009186
9187 Supported in default-server: No
9188
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009189send-proxy-v2
9190 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9191 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9192 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9193 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9194 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9195 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9196 option of the "bind" keyword.
9197
9198 Supported in default-server: No
9199
9200send-proxy-v2-ssl
9201 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9202 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9203 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9204 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9205 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9206 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9207 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9208 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9209
9210 Supported in default-server: No
9211
9212send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9213 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9214 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9215 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9216 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9217 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9218 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9219 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9220 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9221 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9222
9223 Supported in default-server: No
9224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009225slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009226 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9227 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9228 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9229 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9230 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9231 parameters :
9232
9233 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9234 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9235
9236 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9237 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9238 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9239 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9240
9241 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9242 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9243 seen as failed.
9244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009245 Supported in default-server: Yes
9246
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009247source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009248source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009249source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009250 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9251 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9252 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9253 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9254
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009255 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9256 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9257 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9258 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9259 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9260 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9261 server.
9262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009263 Supported in default-server: No
9264
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009265ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009266 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9267 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9268 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9269 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9270 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9271 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009272 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009273
9274 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009276track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009277 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9278 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9279 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9280 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009281 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009283 Supported in default-server: No
9284
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009285verify [none|required]
9286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009287 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9288 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9289 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9290 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009291 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9292 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9293 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009294
9295 Supported in default-server: No
9296
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009297verifyhost <hostname>
9298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9299 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9300 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9301 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9302 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9303 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9304
9305 Supported in default-server: No
9306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009307weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009308 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9309 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9310 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009311 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9312 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9313 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9314 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9315 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9316 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009318 Supported in default-server: Yes
9319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009320
93216. HTTP header manipulation
9322---------------------------
9323
9324In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9325response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9326request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9327which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009328against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009329
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009330If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9331to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9332but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9333HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9334stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9335because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9336a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9337still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009339This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9340in section 4.2 :
9341
9342 - reqadd <string>
9343 - reqallow <search>
9344 - reqiallow <search>
9345 - reqdel <search>
9346 - reqidel <search>
9347 - reqdeny <search>
9348 - reqideny <search>
9349 - reqpass <search>
9350 - reqipass <search>
9351 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9352 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9353 - reqtarpit <search>
9354 - reqitarpit <search>
9355 - rspadd <string>
9356 - rspdel <search>
9357 - rspidel <search>
9358 - rspdeny <search>
9359 - rspideny <search>
9360 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9361 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9362
9363With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9364is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9365parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9366prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9367Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9368
9369 \t for a tab
9370 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9371 \n for a new line (LF)
9372 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9373 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9374 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9375 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9376 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9377
9378The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9379portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9380above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9381regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93829 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9383is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9384
9385The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9386after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9387
9388Notes related to these keywords :
9389---------------------------------
9390 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9391 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9392 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9393
9394 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9395 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9396 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9397
9398 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9399 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9400 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9401 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9402 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9403
9404 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9405 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9406 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9407 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9408 useless headers before adding new ones.
9409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009410 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009411 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9412
9413 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9414 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9415 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9416
9417 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9418 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009419 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009420
9421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094227. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9423----------------------------------
9424
9425Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9426client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9427The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9428these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9429but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9430data called patterns.
9431
9432
94337.1. ACL basics
9434---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009435
9436The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9437content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9438from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9439simple :
9440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009441 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009442 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009443 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9444 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009446The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9447adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009448
9449In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009451 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009452
9453This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9454Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9455and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009456an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9457conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9458as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9459are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009460
9461ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9462'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9463which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9464
9465There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9466performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9469specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9470this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009471methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9472ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009473
9474Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9475 - boolean
9476 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9477 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9478 - string
9479 - data block
9480
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009481Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9482converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9483would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9484The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9485which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9486
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009487Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9488keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9489fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9490which are summarized in the table below :
9491
9492 +---------------------+-----------------+
9493 | Sample or converter | Default |
9494 | output type | matching method |
9495 +---------------------+-----------------+
9496 | boolean | bool |
9497 +---------------------+-----------------+
9498 | integer | int |
9499 +---------------------+-----------------+
9500 | ip | ip |
9501 +---------------------+-----------------+
9502 | string | str |
9503 +---------------------+-----------------+
9504 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9505 +---------------------+-----------------+
9506
9507Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9508matching method, see below.
9509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009510The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9511 - boolean
9512 - integer or integer range
9513 - IP address / network
9514 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9515 - regular expression
9516 - hex block
9517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009518The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9519
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009520 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9521 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009522 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009523 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009524 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009525 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009526 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009528The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9529read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9530if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9531lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9532will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9533beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9534a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9535lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9536exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9537
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009538The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9539parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9540ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9541a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9542check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9543
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009544The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9545socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9546file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009548Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9549loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9550
9551 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9552
9553In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9554the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9555case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9556as well.
9557
9558The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9559sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9560do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9561methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9562is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9563obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9564followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9565default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9566that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9567string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9568
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009569The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9570By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9571string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9572resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9573server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9574waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9575flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9576function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009578There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9579sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9580be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009581
9582 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9583 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009584 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9585 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9586 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9587 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009588
9589 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9590 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009591 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009592
9593 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009595
9596 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009597 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009598
9599 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9600 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9601
9602 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9603 binary or string samples.
9604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9606 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9609 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9610 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9613 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009615 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9616 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009618 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9619 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009621 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9622 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009623 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9626 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9627 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009628
9629For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9630request, it is possible to do :
9631
9632 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9633
9634In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9635buffer, one would use the following acl :
9636
9637 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9638
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009639On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9640possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9641
9642 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009644All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9645criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9646method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9647to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9648criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9649the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009652the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9653For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9656 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9657 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9658 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009659
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009660
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009661The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9662types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9663combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9664brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9665default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009667 +-------------------------------------------------+
9668 | Input sample type |
9669 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009670 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009671 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9672 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9673 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009674 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009675 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009676 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009677 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009678 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009680 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009681 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009682 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009683 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009684 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009685 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009686 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009687 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009688 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009689 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009690 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009692 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009694 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9696 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009698
9699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097007.1.1. Matching booleans
9701------------------------
9702
9703In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9704Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9705When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9706that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9707
9708Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9709return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9710"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097137.1.2. Matching integers
9714------------------------
9715
9716Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9717enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9718to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9719
9720Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9721matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9722lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009723
9724For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9725unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9726representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9727
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009728As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9729two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9730instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9731ranges and operators.
9732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009733For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009734operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9735Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9736of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009739
9740 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9741 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9742 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9743 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9744 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009746For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009747
9748 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9749
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009750This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9751
9752 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9753
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097557.1.3. Matching strings
9756-----------------------
9757
9758String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9759different forms :
9760
9761 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9762 patterns ;
9763
9764 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9765 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9766
9767 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9768 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9769
9770 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9771 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9772
9773 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9774 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9775 matches.
9776
9777 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9778 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9779 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009780
9781String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9782exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9783characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9784string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9785to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009786before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009787
9788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097897.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9790---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009791
9792Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9793they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9794possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9795passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9796the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009797the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9798match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009799
9800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098017.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9802-------------------------------------
9803
9804It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9805not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9806a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9807to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9808digits may be used upper or lower case.
9809
9810Example :
9811 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9812 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9813
9814
98157.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9816---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009817
9818IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9819netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9820within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009821host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009822difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9823at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9824does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9825parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009826
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009827IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9828Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9829trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9830IPv6 patterns.
9831
9832HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9833following situations :
9834 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9835 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9836 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9837 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9838 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9839 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9840 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9841 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9842 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9843 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009845
98467.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9847----------------------------------
9848
9849Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9850combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9851
9852 - AND (implicit)
9853 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9854 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009856A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009858 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009860Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9861indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9864"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9865requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9866is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9867
9868 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9869 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9870 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9871 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9872
9873To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9874and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9875
9876 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9877 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9878 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9879 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9880
9881 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9882 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9883 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9884 use_backend www if host_www
9885
9886It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9887expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9888be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9889the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9890
9891 The following rule :
9892
9893 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9894 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9895
9896 Can also be written that way :
9897
9898 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9899
9900It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9901to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9902simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9903sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9904good use is the following :
9905
9906 With named ACLs :
9907
9908 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9909 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9910 monitor fail if site_dead
9911
9912 With anonymous ACLs :
9913
9914 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9915
9916See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9917
9918
99197.3. Fetching samples
9920---------------------
9921
9922Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9923against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9924sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9925ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9926of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9927available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9928
9929This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9930Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9931compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9932deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9933
9934The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9935matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9936method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9937indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9938
9939As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9940when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9941mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9942the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9943ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9944
9945Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9946multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9947when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9948incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9949are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9950is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9951all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9952
9953Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9954 - name
9955 - name(arg1)
9956 - name(arg1,arg2)
9957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009958
99597.3.1. Converters
9960-----------------
9961
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009962Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9963of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9964is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9965was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9966has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9967unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9968
9969These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9970sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9971the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9972support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009974The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009975
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009976base64
9977 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9978 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9979 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9980
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009981hex
9982 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9983 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9984 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9985 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009986
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009987http_date([<offset>])
9988 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9989 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9990 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9991 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9992 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9993 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009994
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009995ipmask(<mask>)
9996 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9997 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9998 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9999 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10000
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010001language(<value>[,<default>])
10002 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10003 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10004 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10005 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10006 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10007 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10008 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10009 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10010 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10011 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10012 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10013 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010014
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010015 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010017 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10018 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010019
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010020 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10021 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10022 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10023 use_backend spanish if es
10024 use_backend french if fr
10025 use_backend english if en
10026 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010027
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010028lower
10029 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10030 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10031 type. The result is of type string.
10032
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010033map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10034map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10035map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10036 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10037 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10038 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10039 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10040 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10041 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10042 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10043 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010044
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010045 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10046 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10047 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010049 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10050 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010052 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10053 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10054 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10055 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010056 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10057 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010058 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10059 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10060 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10062 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10064 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10066 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10068 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10070 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010073 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10074 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10075 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10076 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10077 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010078
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010079 Example :
10080
10081 # this is a comment and is ignored
10082 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10083 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10084 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10085 | | | `---------- value
10086 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10087 | `---------------------------- key
10088 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10089
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010090upper
10091 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10092 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10093 type. The result is of type string.
10094
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100967.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010097--------------------------------------------
10098
10099A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10100not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10101"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10102The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10103
10104always_false : boolean
10105 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10106 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10107
10108always_true : boolean
10109 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10110 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10111
10112avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010113 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010114 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10115 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10116 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10117 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10118 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10119 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10120 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10121 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10122 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10123 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10124 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10125 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10126 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010128be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010129 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10130 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10131 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10132 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10133 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010135be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10136 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10137 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10138 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10139 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10140 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10141 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010142
10143 Example :
10144 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10145 backend dynamic
10146 mode http
10147 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10148 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010150connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10151 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010152 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010153 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10154 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010155
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010156 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010157 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010158 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010160 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10161 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010162
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010163 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010164 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010165 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010166 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10167 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010169 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010170
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010171 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10172 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010173 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010174 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010175
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010176date([<offset>]) : integer
10177 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10178 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10179 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10180 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010181 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10182
10183 Example :
10184
10185 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10186 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010187
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010188env(<name>) : string
10189 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10190 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10191 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10192 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10193 certain way.
10194
10195 Examples :
10196 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10197 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10198
10199 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10200 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010202fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10203 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010204 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10205 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010206 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10207 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10208 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10209 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10210 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10213 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10214 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10215 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10216 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10217 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10218 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10219 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10220 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010221
10222 Example :
10223 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10224 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10225 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10226 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10227 frontend mail
10228 bind :25
10229 mode tcp
10230 maxconn 100
10231 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10232 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10233 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10234 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010235
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010236nbproc : integer
10237 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10238 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10239 and debugging purposes.
10240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10242 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10243 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10244 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010245 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10246 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10247 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010248
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010249proc : integer
10250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10251 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10252 debugging purposes.
10253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010254queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010255 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10256 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10257 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10259 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10260 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10261 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10262 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10263
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010264rand([<range>]) : integer
10265 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10266 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10267 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10268 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10269 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010271srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10273 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10274 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10275 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10276 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10277 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10278 methods.
10279
10280srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10281 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10282 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10283 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10284 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10285 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10286 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10287 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10288
10289srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10290 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10291 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010292 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10294 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10295 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10296 overloading servers).
10297
10298 Example :
10299 # Redirect to a separate back
10300 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10301 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10302 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10303
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010304stopping : boolean
10305 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10306 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10307 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010309table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10310 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10311 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10312
10313table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10314 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10315 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10316 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10317
10318
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200103197.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010320----------------------------------
10321
10322The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10323closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10324methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10325sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10326TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010327the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10328counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10329"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010330argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10331the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10332this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010333
10334be_id : integer
10335 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10336 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10337
10338dst : ip
10339 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10340 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10341 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10342 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10343 RFC 4291.
10344
10345dst_conn : integer
10346 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10347 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10348 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10349 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10350 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10351 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10352 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10353 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010355dst_port : integer
10356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10357 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10358 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10359 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10360 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10361 an HTTP header.
10362
10363fe_id : integer
10364 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10365 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10366 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010368sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010369sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10370sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10371sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010372 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10373 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10374 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010376sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010377sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10378sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10379sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010380 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10381 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10382 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010384sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010385sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10386sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10387sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010388 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10389 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010390 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10391 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10392 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010393
10394 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10395 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010396 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10397 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10398 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010399 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10400 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010402sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010403sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10404sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10405sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010406 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10407 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10408
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010409sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010410sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10411sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10412sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010413 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10414 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10415 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010417sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010418sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10419sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10420sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010421 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10422 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10423 See also src_conn_rate.
10424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010425sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010426sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10427sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10428sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010429 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010430 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010431
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010432sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010433sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10434sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10435sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010436 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10437 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10438 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010439 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10440 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10441 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010442
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010443sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010444sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10445sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10446sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010447 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10448 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10449 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10450
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010451sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010452sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10453sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10454sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010455 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10456 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10457 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10458 src_http_err_rate.
10459
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010460sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010461sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10462sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10463sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010464 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10465 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10466 src_http_req_cnt.
10467
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010468sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010469sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10470sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10471sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010472 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10473 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10474 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10475 src_http_req_rate.
10476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010477sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010478sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10479sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10480sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010481 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010482 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10483 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10484 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10485 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010486
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010487 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10488 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010489 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10490
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010491sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010492sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10493sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10494sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010495 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10496 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10497 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010499sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010500sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10501sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10502sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010503 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10504 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10505 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010507sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010508sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10509sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10510sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010511 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10512 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10513 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10514 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010515 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010516 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010518sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010519sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10520sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10521sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010522 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10523 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10524 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10525 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10526 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010527 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010528
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010529sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010530sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10531sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10532sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010533 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10534 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10535 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010537sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010538sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10539sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10540sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010541 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10542 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010543 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010544 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10545 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010546 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10547 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10548 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010550so_id : integer
10551 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10552 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10553 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010555src : ip
10556 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10557 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10558 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10559 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10560 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10561 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10562 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010563
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010564 Example:
10565 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10566 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010568src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10569 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10570 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10571 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010572 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10575 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10576 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010577 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010578 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10581 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10582 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10583 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10584 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10585 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10586 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010587
10588 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10589 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10590 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10591 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010592 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010593 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10594 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010596src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010597 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010598 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010599 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010600 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010603 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010604 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10605 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010606 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10609 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10610 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10611 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010612 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010615 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010617 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010618 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010620src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010621 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010622 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010623 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10624 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010625 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10626 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10627 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010629src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10630 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10631 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010632 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010633 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010634 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010636src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10637 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10638 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10639 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10640 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010641 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010643src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10644 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10645 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10646 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010647 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010649src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10650 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10651 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10652 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010653 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010654 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010656src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10657 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10658 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10659 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010660 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010661 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10662 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010663
10664 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010665 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010666 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010668src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010669 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10670 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10671 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10672 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10673 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010675src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010676 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10677 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10678 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10679 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10680 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010682src_port : integer
10683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10684 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10685 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10686 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010688src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10689 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010690 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10691 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10692 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010693 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010695src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10696 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10697 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10698 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10699 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010700 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010702src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10703 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10704 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10705 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10706 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10707 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10708 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10709 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10710 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010711
10712 Example :
10713 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10714 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10715 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10716 listen ssh
10717 bind :22
10718 mode tcp
10719 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010720 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010722 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010724srv_id : integer
10725 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10726 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10727 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010728
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107307.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010731----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10734closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10735when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10736usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010737future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010738
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010739ssl_bc : boolean
10740 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10741 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10742 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10743
10744ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10745 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10746 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10747
10748ssl_bc_cipher : string
10749 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10750 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10751
10752ssl_bc_protocol : string
10753 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10754 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10755
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010756ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010757 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010758 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10759 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010760
10761ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10762 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10763 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10764 if session was reused or not.
10765
10766ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10767 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10768 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010770ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10771 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10772 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10773 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10774 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10775 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010777ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10778 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10779 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10780 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10781 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010782
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010783ssl_c_der : binary
10784 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10785 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10786 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788ssl_c_err : integer
10789 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10790 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10791 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10792 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10793 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010795ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10796 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10797 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10798 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10799 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10800 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10801 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10802 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10803 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010805ssl_c_key_alg : string
10806 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10807 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10808 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010810ssl_c_notafter : string
10811 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10812 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10813 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010815ssl_c_notbefore : string
10816 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10817 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10818 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010820ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10821 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10822 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10823 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10824 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10825 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10826 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10827 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10828 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830ssl_c_serial : binary
10831 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10832 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10833 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010835ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10836 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10837 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10838 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010839 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10840 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10841
10842 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10845 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10846 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10847 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010849ssl_c_used : boolean
10850 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10851 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010853ssl_c_verify : integer
10854 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10855 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10856 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10857 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010859ssl_c_version : integer
10860 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10861 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010862
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010863ssl_f_der : binary
10864 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10865 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10866 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10869 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10870 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10871 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10872 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010873 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10875 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10876 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010878ssl_f_key_alg : string
10879 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10880 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10881 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883ssl_f_notafter : string
10884 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10885 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10886 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010888ssl_f_notbefore : string
10889 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10890 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10891 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10894 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10895 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10896 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10897 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10898 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10899 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10900 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10901 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010903ssl_f_serial : binary
10904 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10905 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10906 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010907
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010908ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10909 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10910 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10911 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010913ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10914 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10915 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10916 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010918ssl_f_version : integer
10919 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10920 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10921
10922ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010923 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10924 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10925 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927 Example :
10928 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10929 listen http-https
10930 bind :80
10931 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10932 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10933
10934ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10935 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10936 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10937
10938ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010939 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10941 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10942 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10943 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10944 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10945 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10946 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10947 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010949ssl_fc_cipher : string
10950 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10951 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010953ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010954 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10955 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010956 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10957 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10958 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10959 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010961ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10962 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010963 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10964 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10965 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10966 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010969 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10971 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10972 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10973 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10974 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10975 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10976 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010978ssl_fc_protocol : string
10979 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10980 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010981
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010982ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010983 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010984 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10985 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010987ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10988 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10989 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10990 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10991 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010993ssl_fc_sni : string
10994 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10995 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10996 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10997 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10998 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10999
11000 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11001 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11002 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011003 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11004 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11008 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11011 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11012 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011013
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011014
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110157.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011016------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011018Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11019sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11020only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11021For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11022be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11023can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11024sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11025for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11026content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11029 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11030 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11031 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011033payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11034 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11035 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11036 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038req.len : integer
11039req_len : integer (deprecated)
11040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11041 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11042 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11043 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11044 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11045 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11046 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11047 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011049req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11050 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011051 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11052 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11053 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11054 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 ACL alternatives :
11057 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011059req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11060 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11061 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11062 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11063 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065 ACL alternatives :
11066 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011068 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070req.proto_http : boolean
11071req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11072 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11073 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11074 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11075 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11076 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11077 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11078 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 Example:
11081 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11082 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11083 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011084 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011086req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11087rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11088 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11089 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11090 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11091 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11092 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11093 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11094 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11097 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11098 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11099 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11100 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11101 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103 ACL derivatives :
11104 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106 Example :
11107 listen tse-farm
11108 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11109 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11110 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11111 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11112 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11113 persist rdp-cookie
11114 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11115 # This is only useful makes sense if
11116 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11117 stick-table type string size 204800
11118 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11119 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11120 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11123 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11126rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11127 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11128 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11129 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11130 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132 ACL derivatives :
11133 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011135req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11136req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11137 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11138 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11139 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11140 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11141 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11142 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11143 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011145req.ssl_sni : string
11146req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11147 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11148 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11149 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11150 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11151 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11152 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11153 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11154 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11155 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11156 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11157 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11158 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011160 ACL derivatives :
11161 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163 Examples :
11164 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11165 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11166 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11167 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11168 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11171rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11172 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11173 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11174 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11175 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11176 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11177 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11178 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180req.ssl_ver : integer
11181req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11182 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11183 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11184 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11185 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11186 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11187 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11188 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11189 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11190 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011192 ACL derivatives :
11193 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011194
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011195res.len : integer
11196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11197 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11198 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11199 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11200 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11201 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11202 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11203 content inspection.
11204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011205res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11206 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011207 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11208 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11209 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11210 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11213 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11214 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11215 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11216 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011218 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011220wait_end : boolean
11221 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11222 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11223 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11224 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11225 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11226 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11227 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11228 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230 Examples :
11231 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11232 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11233 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011235 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11236 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11237 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11238 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11239 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11240 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11241 tcp-request content reject
11242
11243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112447.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011245--------------------------------------
11246
11247It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11248This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11249data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11250its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11251HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11252content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11253to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11254more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11255response are indexed.
11256
11257base : string
11258 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11259 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11260 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11261 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11262 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11263 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11264 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11265 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11266
11267 ACL derivatives :
11268 base : exact string match
11269 base_beg : prefix match
11270 base_dir : subdir match
11271 base_dom : domain match
11272 base_end : suffix match
11273 base_len : length match
11274 base_reg : regex match
11275 base_sub : substring match
11276
11277base32 : integer
11278 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11279 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11280 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11281 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11282
11283base32+src : binary
11284 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11285 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11286 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11287 per-URL counters.
11288
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011289capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11290 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11291 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11292 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11293
11294capture.req.method : string
11295 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11296 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11297 because it's allocated.
11298
11299capture.req.uri : string
11300 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11301 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11302 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11303 allocated.
11304
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011305capture.req.ver : string
11306 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11307 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11308 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11309
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011310capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11311 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11312 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11313 The first entry is an index of 0.
11314 See also: "capture response header"
11315
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011316capture.res.ver : string
11317 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11318 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11319 persistent flag.
11320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011321req.cook([<name>]) : string
11322cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11323 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11324 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11325 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11326 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11327 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11328 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11329 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11330 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11331
11332 ACL derivatives :
11333 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11334 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11335 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11336 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11337 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11338 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11339 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11340 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11343cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11344 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11345 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11348cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11349 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11350 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11351 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11352 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11356 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11357 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11358 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11359 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11360 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11361 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11362 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11363 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11364 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11367 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11368 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11369 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11370 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011371 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011373req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11374 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11375 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11376 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11377 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11378 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11379 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11380 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11381 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011383req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11384 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11385 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11386 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11387 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11390 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11391 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11392 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11393 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11394 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11395 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11396 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11397 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11398 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11399 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11400 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011402 ACL derivatives :
11403 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11404 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11405 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11406 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11407 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11408 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11409 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11410 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11411
11412req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11413hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11414 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11415 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11416 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11417 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11418 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11419 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11420 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11421 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11422 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11423
11424req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11425hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11426 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11427 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11428 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11429 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11430 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11431 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11432 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11433 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11434
11435req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11436hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11437 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11438 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11439 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11440 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11441 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11442 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11443 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11444
11445http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11446 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11447 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11448 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11449 basic auth is supported.
11450
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011451http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11452 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11453 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11454 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11455 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011456 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11457 basic auth is supported.
11458
11459 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011460 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11461 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11462 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11463 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011464
11465http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011466 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11467 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011468 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11469 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471method : integer + string
11472 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11473 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11474 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11475 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11476 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11477 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11478 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480 ACL derivatives :
11481 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011483 Example :
11484 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11485 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11486 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011488path : string
11489 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11490 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11491 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11492 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11493 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11494 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11495 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 ACL derivatives :
11498 path : exact string match
11499 path_beg : prefix match
11500 path_dir : subdir match
11501 path_dom : domain match
11502 path_end : suffix match
11503 path_len : length match
11504 path_reg : regex match
11505 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507req.ver : string
11508req_ver : string (deprecated)
11509 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11510 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11511 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513 ACL derivatives :
11514 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516res.comp : boolean
11517 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11518 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11519 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521res.comp_algo : string
11522 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11523 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11524 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526res.cook([<name>]) : string
11527scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11528 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11529 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11530 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532 ACL derivatives :
11533 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011535res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11536scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11537 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11538 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11539 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011541res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11542scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11543 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11544 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11545 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11549 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11550 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11551 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11552 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11553 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11554 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11555 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11556 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011558res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11559 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11560 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11561 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11562 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11563 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11566shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11567 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11568 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11569 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11570 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11571 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11572 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11573 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11574 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011576 ACL derivatives :
11577 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11578 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11579 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11580 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11581 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11582 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11583 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11584 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11585
11586res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11587shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11588 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11589 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11590 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11591 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11592 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11595shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11596 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11597 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11598 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11599 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11600 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11601 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011603res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11604shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11605 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11606 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11607 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11608 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11609 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11610 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011612res.ver : string
11613resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11614 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11615 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011617 ACL derivatives :
11618 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011620set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11621 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11622 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11623 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11624 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011626 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11627 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011629 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011631status : integer
11632 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11633 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11634 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636url : string
11637 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11638 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11639 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11640 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11641 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11642 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11643 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645 ACL derivatives :
11646 url : exact string match
11647 url_beg : prefix match
11648 url_dir : subdir match
11649 url_dom : domain match
11650 url_end : suffix match
11651 url_len : length match
11652 url_reg : regex match
11653 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655url_ip : ip
11656 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11657 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11658 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11659 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11660 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11661 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11662 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011664url_port : integer
11665 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11666 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11667 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11668 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011670urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11671url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11672 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11673 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11674 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11675 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11676 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11677 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11678 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11679 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11680 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682 ACL derivatives :
11683 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11684 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11685 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11686 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11687 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11688 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11689 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11690 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011691
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011693 Example :
11694 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11695 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11696 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11697 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011699urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11700 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11701 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11702 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011703
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117057.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011706---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011708Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11709every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011710order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011712ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11713---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011714FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011715HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011716HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11717HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011718HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11719HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11720HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11721HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11722LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011723METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11724METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11725METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11726METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11727METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11728METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011729RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011730REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011731TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011732WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11733---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011734
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117368. Logging
11737----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011739One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11740provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11741very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11742provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11743state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011744to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011745headers.
11746
11747In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11748about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11749send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11750
11751 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11752 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11753 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11754 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11755 at the termination.
11756
11757The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11758allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11759as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11760while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11761real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11762delay.
11763
11764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117658.1. Log levels
11766---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011767
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011768TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011769source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011770HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11771in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11772track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11773syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11774about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011775
11776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117778.2. Log formats
11778----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011779
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011780HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011781and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11782slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11783options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011784
11785 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11786 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11787 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11788 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11789 extents.
11790
11791 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11792 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11793 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11794 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11795 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11796
11797 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11798 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11799 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11800 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11801 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11802
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011803 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11804 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11805 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11806 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11807
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011808 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011810Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11811specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11812field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11813servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11814always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11815identifier.
11816
11817Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11818 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11819 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11820 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11821 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11822
11823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118248.2.1. Default log format
11825-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011826
11827This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11828as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11829format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11830
11831 Example :
11832 listen www
11833 mode http
11834 log global
11835 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11836
11837 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11838 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11839 (www/HTTP)
11840
11841 Field Format Extract from the example above
11842 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11843 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11844 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11845 4 'to' to
11846 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11847 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11848
11849Detailed fields description :
11850 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11851 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11852 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11853 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11854 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11855 and processed the connection.
11856 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11857
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011858In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11859"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11860connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11861
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011862It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11863will eventually disappear.
11864
11865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118668.2.2. TCP log format
11867---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011868
11869The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11870is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11871information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11872counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11873emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11874environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11875the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11876sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011877specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11878not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11879fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11880marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011881
11882 Example :
11883 frontend fnt
11884 mode tcp
11885 option tcplog
11886 log global
11887 default_backend bck
11888
11889 backend bck
11890 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11891
11892 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11893 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11894 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11895
11896 Field Format Extract from the example above
11897 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11898 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11899 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11900 4 frontend_name fnt
11901 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11902 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11903 7 bytes_read* 212
11904 8 termination_state --
11905 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11906 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11907
11908Detailed fields description :
11909 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011910 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11911 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11912 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11913 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11914 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011915
11916 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011917 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11918 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11919 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011920
11921 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11922 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11923 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11924 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11925
11926 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11927 and processed the connection.
11928
11929 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11930 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11931 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11932 applications.
11933
11934 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11935 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11936 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11937 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11938 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11939
11940 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11941 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11942 See "Timers" below for more details.
11943
11944 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11945 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11946 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11947 "Timers" below for more details.
11948
11949 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011950 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011951 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11952 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11953 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11954 details.
11955
11956 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11957 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11958 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11959 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11960 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11961
11962 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11963 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11964 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11965 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11966 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11967 for more details.
11968
11969 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011970 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011971 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11972 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11973 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011974 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011975
11976 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11977 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11978 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11979 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11980 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11981 caused by a denial of service attack.
11982
11983 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11984 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11985 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11986 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11987 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11988 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11989 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11990 denial of service attack.
11991
11992 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11993 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11994 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11995 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11996 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11997 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11998 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11999 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12000 be processed than on other servers.
12001
12002 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12003 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12004 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12005 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12006 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12007 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12008 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12009 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12010 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12011 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12012 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12013 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12014 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12015
12016 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12017 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12018 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12019 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12020 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12021 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12022 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12023 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12024
12025 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12026 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12027 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12028 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12029 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12030 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12031 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12032 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12033 occurs.
12034
12035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120368.2.3. HTTP log format
12037----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012038
12039The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12040is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12041the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12042are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12043emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12044generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12045"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12046which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012047frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12048is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012049
12050Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12051slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12052with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12053
12054 Example :
12055 frontend http-in
12056 mode http
12057 option httplog
12058 log global
12059 default_backend bck
12060
12061 backend static
12062 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12063
12064 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12065 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12066 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012067 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012068
12069 Field Format Extract from the example above
12070 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12071 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12072 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12073 4 frontend_name http-in
12074 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12075 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12076 7 status_code 200
12077 8 bytes_read* 2750
12078 9 captured_request_cookie -
12079 10 captured_response_cookie -
12080 11 termination_state ----
12081 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12082 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12083 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12084 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12085 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012087
12088Detailed fields description :
12089 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012090 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12091 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12092 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12093 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12094 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012095
12096 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012097 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12098 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12099 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100
12101 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12102 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12103 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12104 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12105 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12106
12107 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12108 and processed the connection.
12109
12110 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12111 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12112 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12113
12114 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12115 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12116 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12117 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12118 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12119 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12120
12121 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12122 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12123 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12124 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12125 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12126 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12127
12128 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12129 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12130 See "Timers" below for more details.
12131
12132 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12133 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12134 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12135 below for more details.
12136
12137 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12138 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12139 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12140 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12141 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12142 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12143 for more details.
12144
12145 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012146 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12148 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12149 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12150 details.
12151
12152 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12153 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12154 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12155
12156 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12157 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12158 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12159 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12160 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12161 overflowing.
12162
12163 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12164 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12165 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12166 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12167 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12168 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12169 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12170 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12171
12172 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12173 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12174 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12175 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12176 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12177 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12178 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12179 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12180
12181 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12182 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12183 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12184 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12185 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12186 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12187 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12188
12189 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012190 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012191 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12192 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12193 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012194 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012195 system.
12196
12197 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12198 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12199 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12200 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12201 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12202 caused by a denial of service attack.
12203
12204 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12205 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12206 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12207 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12208 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12209 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12210 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12211 denial of service attack.
12212
12213 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12214 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12215 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12216 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12217 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12218 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12219 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12220 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12221 processed than on other servers.
12222
12223 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12224 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12225 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12226 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12227 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12228 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12229 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12230 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12231 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12232 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12233 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12234 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12235 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12236
12237 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12238 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12239 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12240 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12241 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12242 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12243 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12244 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12245
12246 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12247 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12248 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12249 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12250 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12251 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12252 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12253 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12254 occurs.
12255
12256 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12257 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12258 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12259 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12260 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12261 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12262 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12263 cookies" below for more details.
12264
12265 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12266 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12267 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12268 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12269 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12270 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12271 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12272 and cookies" below for more details.
12273
12274 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12275 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12276 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12277 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12278 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12279 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12280 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12281 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12282
12283
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122848.2.4. Custom log format
12285------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012286
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012287The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012288mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012289
12290HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12291Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12292separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12293prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12294
12295Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12296variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12297string formats ("Q").
12298
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012299If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012300as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012301less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12302the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12303
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012304Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012305In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012306in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012307
12308Flags are :
12309 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012310 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012311
12312 Example:
12313
12314 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12315 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12316
12317At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12318
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012319 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12320 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012321
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012322the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012323
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012324 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012325 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012326 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012327
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012328and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12329
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012330 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012331 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12332
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012333Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12334
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012335 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012336 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012337 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12338 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12339 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012340 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12341 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12342 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012343 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012344 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012345 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012346 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012347 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012348 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012349 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12350 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012351 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012352 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12353 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012354 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012355 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12356 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012357 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12358 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12359 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012360 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012361 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12362 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012363 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012364 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12365 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12366 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012367 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012368 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12369 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12370 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12371 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012372 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012373 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012374 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012375 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012376 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012377 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012378 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12379 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12380 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012381 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012382 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12383 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012384 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012385 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012386 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012387 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012388
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012389 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012390
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012391
123928.2.5. Error log format
12393-----------------------
12394
12395When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12396protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12397By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12398"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12399will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12400logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12401
12402The format looks like this :
12403
12404 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12405 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12406 Connection error during SSL handshake
12407
12408 Field Format Extract from the example above
12409 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12410 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12411 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12412 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12413 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12414
12415These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12416failures.
12417
12418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124198.3. Advanced logging options
12420-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421
12422Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12423just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12424options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12425for more information about their usage.
12426
12427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12429------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012430
12431It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12432haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12433commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12434monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12435ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12436
12437 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12438 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12439 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12440 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12441
12442 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12443 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12444 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012445 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012446 such as other load-balancers.
12447
12448 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12449 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12450 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12451
12452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12454----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012455
12456The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12457what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12458or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12459"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12460just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12461log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12462after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12463is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12464with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12465with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12466
12467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12469------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012470
12471Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12472for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12473"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12474retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12475raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12476a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12477file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12478you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12479"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12480
12481
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12483--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012484
12485Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12486multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12487them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12488"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12489logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12490error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12491and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12492too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12493useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12494alternative.
12495
12496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124978.4. Timing events
12498------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012499
12500Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12501reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12502the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12503frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12504mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12505
12506 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12507 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12508 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12509 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12510 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12511
12512 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12513 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12514 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12515 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12516 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12517
12518 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12519 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12520 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12521 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12522 connection never established.
12523
12524 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12525 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12526 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12527 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12528 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12529 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12530 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12531 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12532 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12533 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12534 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12535
12536 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12537 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12538 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12539 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012540 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012541
12542 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12543
12544 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12545 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12546 negative.
12547
12548These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12549protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12550that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012551due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012552close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12553session has been aborted on timeout.
12554
12555Most common cases :
12556
12557 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12558 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12559 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12560 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12561 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12562 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12563 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12564 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12565 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012566 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12567 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12568 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012569
12570 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12571 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12572 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12573 of ms on remote networks.
12574
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012575 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12576 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12577 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012578
12579 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12580 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12581 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12582 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12583 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12584 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12585 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12586 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12587 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12588 to the server until another one is released.
12589
12590Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12591
12592 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12593 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12594 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12595
12596 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12597 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12598 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12599
12600 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12601 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12602 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12603 flags.
12604
12605 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12606 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12607 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12608 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12609 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12610 the client connection was maintained open.
12611
12612 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012613 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012614 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12615 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12616
12617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126188.5. Session state at disconnection
12619-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012620
12621TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12622"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
126232-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12624each of which has a special meaning :
12625
12626 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12627 session to terminate :
12628
12629 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12630
12631 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12632 server explicitly refused it.
12633
12634 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12635 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12636 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12637 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012638 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12639
12640 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12641 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012642
12643 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12644 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12645 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12646 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12647 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12648
12649 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12650 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12651 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12652 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12653 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12654
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012655 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12656 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12657
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012658 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12659 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12660 backup connections when going up.
12661
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012662 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012664 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12665 send or receive data.
12666
12667 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12668 send or receive data.
12669
12670 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12671 with nothing left in the buffers.
12672
12673 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12674
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012675 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012676 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12677
12678 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12679 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12680 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12681 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12682 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12683
12684 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12685 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12686
12687 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12688 server (HTTP only).
12689
12690 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12691
12692 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12693 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12694 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12695
12696 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12697 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12698 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12699
12700 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12701
12702 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12703 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12704
12705 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12706 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12707 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12708
12709 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12710 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012711 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12712 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012713
12714 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12715 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12716 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12717 another server.
12718
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012719 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012720 server.
12721
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012722 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12723 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12724 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12725 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12726
12727 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12728 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12729 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12730 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12731
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012732 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12733 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12734 "use-server" rule).
12735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012736 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12737
12738 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12739 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12740
12741 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12742
12743 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12744 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12745 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12746
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012747 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12748 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012749 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012750 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12751 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12752
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012753 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12754
12755 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12756 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12757
12758 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12759
12760 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12761
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012762The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12763was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012764helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12765starvation, attacks, etc...
12766
12767The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12768alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12769easier finding and understanding.
12770
12771 Flags Reason
12772
12773 -- Normal termination.
12774
12775 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12776 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12777 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12778 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12779
12780 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12781 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12782 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12783 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12784 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12785 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012786
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012787 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12788 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012789 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012790
12791 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12792 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12793 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12794
12795 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12796 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12797 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12798 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12799 the server takes too long to respond.
12800
12801 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12802 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12803 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12804 long a time to respond.
12805
12806 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12807 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12808 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12809 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012810 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
12811 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012812
12813 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12814 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12815 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12816 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12817 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012818 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau1c3a6122015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012819 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
12820 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
12821 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
12822 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
12823 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
12824 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
12825 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
12826 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
12827 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
12828 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
12829 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
12830 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012831
12832 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12833 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012834 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12835 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12836 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12837 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012838
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012839 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12840 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012842 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012843 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12844 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12845 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12846 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12847 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12848
12849 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12850 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12851 503 or 504 here.
12852
12853 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12854 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12855 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12856 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12857 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12858
12859 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12860 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012861 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012862 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12863 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12864
12865 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12866 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12867 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12868 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12869 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12870 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12871 between haproxy and the server.
12872
12873 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12874 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12875 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12876 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12877 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12878 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12879 solution is to fix the application.
12880
12881 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12882 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12883 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12884 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12885 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12886 external attacks.
12887
12888 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12889 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012890 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012891 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12892 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12893
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012894 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12895 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12896 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012897 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12898 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012899
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012900 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12901 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12902 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12903 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012904 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12905 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12906 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12907 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12908 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012909
12910 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12911 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12912 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12913 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12914
12915 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12916 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12917 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12918 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12919
12920 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12921 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12922 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12923 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12924
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012925The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12926persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12927important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12928re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12929
12930 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12931
12932 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12933 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12934 set on a GET request.
12935
12936 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12937 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012938 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012939 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12940
12941 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12942 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12943 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12944
12945 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12946 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12947 already got a cookie.
12948
12949 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12950 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12951 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12952 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12953 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12954
12955 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12956 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12957 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12958
12959 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12960 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12961 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12962
12963 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12964 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12965
12966 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12967 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12968 then advertised in the response.
12969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129718.6. Non-printable characters
12972-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012973
12974In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12975consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12976converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12977prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12978being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12979escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12980is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12981'}' when logging headers.
12982
12983Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12984issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12985containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12986
12987Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12988the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12989performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12990
12991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12993---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012994
12995Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12996achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012997section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012998cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12999the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13000the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013001locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013002not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13003user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13004a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13005wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13006
13007 Examples :
13008 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13009 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13010
13011 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13012 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13013
13014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13016---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013017
13018Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13019proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13020the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13021server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13022
13023Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13024response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013025section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013026
13027It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013028time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13029appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013030are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13031and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13032follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13033request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13034in the logs.
13035
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013036As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13037frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13038an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13039
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013040 Example :
13041 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13042 listen proxy-out
13043 mode http
13044 option httplog
13045 option logasap
13046 log global
13047 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13048
13049 # log the name of the virtual server
13050 capture request header Host len 20
13051
13052 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13053 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13054
13055 # log the beginning of the referrer
13056 capture request header Referer len 20
13057
13058 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13059 capture response header Server len 20
13060
13061 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13062 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13063
13064 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13065 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13066
13067 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13068 capture response header Via len 20
13069
13070 # log the URL location during a redirection
13071 capture response header Location len 20
13072
13073 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13074 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13075 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13076 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13077 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13078
13079 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13080 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13081 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13082 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013083 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013084
13085 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13086 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13087 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13088 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13089 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013090 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013091
13092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130938.9. Examples of logs
13094---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013095
13096These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13097them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13098reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13099
13100 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13101 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13102 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13103
13104 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13105 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13106
13107 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13108 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13109 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13110
13111 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13112 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13113
13114 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13115 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13116 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13117
13118 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013119 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013120 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13121 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13122
13123 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13124 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13125 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13126
13127 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13128 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013129 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013130 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13131 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13132 to return the 502 and not the server.
13133
13134 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013135 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013136
13137 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13138 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13139 Nothing was sent to any server.
13140
13141 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13142 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13143
13144 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13145 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13146 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13147 send a 408 return code to the client.
13148
13149 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13150 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13151
13152 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13153 5 seconds ("c----").
13154
13155 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13156 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013157 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013158
13159 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013160 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013161 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13162 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13163 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13164 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13165 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013166
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131689. Statistics and monitoring
13169----------------------------
13170
13171It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13172mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13173CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13174Unix socket.
13175
13176
131779.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013178---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013179
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013180The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013181page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13182begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13183represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13184use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13185('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13186(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13187text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13188do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13189use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013190
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013191In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13192that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13193S (Servers).
13194
13195 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13196 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13197 any name for server/listener)
13198 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13199 number queued without a server assigned.
13200 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13201 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13202 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13203 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13204 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13205 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13206 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13207 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13208 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13209 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13210 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13211 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13212 "option checkcache".
13213 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13214 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13215 - read error from the client
13216 - client timeout
13217 - client closed connection
13218 - various bad requests from the client.
13219 - request was tarpitted.
13220 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13221 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13222 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13223 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13224 active servers).
13225 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13226 Some other errors are:
13227 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13228 - failure applying filters to the response.
13229 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13230 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13231 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13232 switched away from.
13233 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13234 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13235 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13236 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13237 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13238 the server is up.)
13239 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13240 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13241 counters for each server.
13242 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13243 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13244 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13245 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13246 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13247 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13248 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13249 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13250 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13251 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13252 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13253 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13254 of times that server was selected.
13255 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13256 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13257 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13258 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13259 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13260 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013261 UNK -> unknown
13262 INI -> initializing
13263 SOCKERR -> socket error
13264 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013265 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013266 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13267 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13268 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13269 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13270 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13271 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13272 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13273 disable-on-404
13274 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13275 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13276 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013277 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13278 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13279 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13280 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13281 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13282 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13283 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13284 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13285 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13286 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13287 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13288 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13289 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13290 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13291 (inc. in eresp)
13292 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13293 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13294 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13295 (CPU/BW limit)
13296 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13297 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13298 server/backend
13299 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13300 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13301 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13302 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13303 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13304 (0 for TCP)
13305 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13306 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013307
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133099.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013310-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013311
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013312The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13313necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13314A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13315issuing commands by hand :
13316
13317 global
13318 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13319 stats timeout 2m
13320
13321It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13322the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13323never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13324situations :
13325
13326 global
13327 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13328 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13329 stats timeout 2m
13330
13331To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13332swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13333to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13334syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13335
13336 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13337 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13338
13339The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13340script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13341for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13342
13343The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13344that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13345editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13346(eg: watch a counter).
13347
13348The socket supports two operation modes :
13349 - interactive
13350 - non-interactive
13351
13352The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13353this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13354sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13355mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13356commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13357example :
13358
13359 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13360
13361The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13362entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13363for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13364sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13365"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13366after processing the last command of the same line.
13367
13368For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13369"prompt" command :
13370
13371 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13372 prompt
13373 > show info
13374 ...
13375 >
13376
13377Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13378delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13379that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13380parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013381
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013382It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13383on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13384own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013385
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013386The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13387If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13388all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13389it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13390
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013391add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013392 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13393 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13394 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13395 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013396
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013397add map <map> <key> <value>
13398 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13399 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013400 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13401 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13402 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013404clear counters
13405 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13406 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13407 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13408 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13409 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13410
13411clear counters all
13412 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13413 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13414 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13415
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013416clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013417 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13418 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13419 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013420
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013421clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013422 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13423 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13424 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013425
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013426clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13427 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13428
13429 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13430 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13431 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13432 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13433 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13434 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13435
13436 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13437
13438 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13439 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13440 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13441 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13442 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13443 the ACLs :
13444
13445 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13446 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13447 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13448 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13449 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13450 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13451
13452 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013453 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13454 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013455
13456 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013457 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013458 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013459 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13460 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13461 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13462 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013463
13464 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13465
13466 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013467 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013468 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13469 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013470 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13471 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13472 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013473
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013474del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13475 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013476 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13477 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13478 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13479 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013480
13481del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013482 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013483 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13484 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13485 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13486 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013487
13488disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013489 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13490
13491 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13492 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13493 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13494 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13495 re-enabled using enable agent.
13496
13497 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13498 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13499 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13500 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13501 otherwise unchanged.
13502
13503 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13504 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13505 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13506
13507 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13508 level "admin".
13509
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013510disable frontend <frontend>
13511 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13512 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13513 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13514 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13515 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13516 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13517 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13518 on the stats page.
13519
13520 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13521 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13522
13523 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13524 level "admin".
13525
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013526disable health <backend>/<server>
13527 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13528 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13529 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13530 agent check forces it down.
13531
13532 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13533 level "admin".
13534
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013535disable server <backend>/<server>
13536 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13537 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13538 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13539 during the maintenance.
13540
13541 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13542 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13543
13544 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013545 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013546
13547 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13548 level "admin".
13549
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013550enable agent <backend>/<server>
13551 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13552
13553 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13554 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13555
13556 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13557 level "admin".
13558
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013559enable frontend <frontend>
13560 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13561 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13562 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13563 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13564 which was disabled.
13565
13566 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13567 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13568
13569 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13570 level "admin".
13571
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013572enable health <backend>/<server>
13573 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13574 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13575
13576 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13577 level "admin".
13578
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013579enable server <backend>/<server>
13580 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13581 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13582
13583 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013584 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013585
13586 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13587 level "admin".
13588
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013589get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013590get acl <acl> <value>
13591 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13592 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13593 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13594 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13595 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013596
13597 The first two words are:
13598
13599 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13600 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13601 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13602
13603 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13604
13605 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13606
13607 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13608
13609 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13610 interpretation of the case.
13611
13612 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13613 useful with regular expressions.
13614
13615 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13616 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13617
13618 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13619 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13620 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13621
13622 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13623
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013624get weight <backend>/<server>
13625 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13626 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13627 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13628 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13629 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013630 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013631
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013632help
13633 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13634 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013635
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013636prompt
13637 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13638 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13639 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13640 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13641 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13642 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13643 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13644 command.
13645
13646quit
13647 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013648
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013649set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013650 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13651 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13652 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013653
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013654set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013655 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13656 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13657 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13658 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13659 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013660 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13661 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13662
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013663set maxconn global <maxconn>
13664 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13665 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13666 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13667 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13668 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13669 setting.
13670
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013671set rate-limit connections global <value>
13672 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13673 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13674 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13675 is passed in number of connections per second.
13676
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013677set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13678 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13679 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013680 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13681 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013682
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013683set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13684 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13685 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13686 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13687 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13688
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013689set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13690 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13691 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13692 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13693 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13694 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13695
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013696set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13697 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13698 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13699 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13700
13701set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13702 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13703 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13704 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13705
13706set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13707 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13708 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13709 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13710 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13711 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13712 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13713 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13714 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13715
13716set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13717 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13718 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13719
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013720set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13721 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13722 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13723 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13724 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13725
13726 Example:
13727 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13728 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13729 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13730 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13731
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013732set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013733 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13734 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13735 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13736 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013737 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13738 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013739
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013740set timeout cli <delay>
13741 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13742 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13743 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13744
13745set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13746 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13747 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013748 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13749 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13750 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13751 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13752 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13753 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13754 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13755 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13756 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13757 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13758 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13759 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13760 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013761
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013762show errors [<iid>]
13763 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13764 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013765 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13766 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13767 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013768
13769 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13770 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13771 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13772 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13773 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13774 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13775 are reported too.
13776
13777 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13778 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13779 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13780 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13781 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13782 code.
13783
13784 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13785 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13786 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13787 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13788 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13789 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13790 line.
13791
13792 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013793 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13794 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013795 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13796 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13797
13798 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13799 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13800 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13801 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13802 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13803 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13804 00204+ minal\r\n
13805 00211 \r\n
13806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013807 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013808 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13809 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13810 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13811 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13812 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13813 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013814
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013815show info
13816 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13817
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013818show map [<map>]
13819 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013820 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13821 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13822 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13823 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13824 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13825 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013826
13827show acl [<acl>]
13828 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013829 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13830 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13831 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13832 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13833 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013834
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013835show pools
13836 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13837 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13838 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13839 the pools.
13840
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013841show sess
13842 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013843 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13844 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13845
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013846show sess <id>
13847 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13848 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13849 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13850 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13851 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013852 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13853 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13854
13855 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13856 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013857
13858show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13859 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13860 possible to dump only selected items :
13861 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13862 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13863 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13864 for example:
13865 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13866 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13867 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13868
13869 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013870 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13871 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013872 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13873 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13874 Nbproc: 1
13875 Process_num: 1
13876 (...)
13877
13878 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13879 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13880 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13881 (...)
13882 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13883
13884 $
13885
13886 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13887 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13888 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13889 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013890 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013891
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013892show table
13893 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13894 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13895 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13896 entries currently in use.
13897
13898 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013899 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013900 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13901 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013902
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013903show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013904 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13905 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13906 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013907 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13908
13909 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13910 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13911 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13912 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13913 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13914
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013915 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13916 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13917 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13918 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13919 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13920 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13921
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013922
13923 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013924 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13925 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013926
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013927 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013928 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013929 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013930 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13931 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13932 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13933 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013934
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013935 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013936 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013937 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13938 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013939
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013940 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13941 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013942 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013943 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13944 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013945
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013946 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13947 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013948 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013949 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13950 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13951
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013952 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13953 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13954 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13955 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13956 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13957
13958 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13959 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13960 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013961 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13962 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013963 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13964 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013965
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013966shutdown frontend <frontend>
13967 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13968 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13969 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13970 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13971 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13972 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13973 once it is terminated.
13974
13975 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13976 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13977
13978 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13979 level "admin".
13980
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013981shutdown session <id>
13982 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13983 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13984 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13985 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13986 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13987 flag in the logs.
13988
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013989shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013990 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13991 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13992 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13993 'K' flag in the logs.
13994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013995/*
13996 * Local variables:
13997 * fill-column: 79
13998 * End:
13999 */